section table of contents page€¦ · if you do not read this entire manual you may miss important...

400
TABLE OF CONTENTS SECTION PAGE 1 INTRODUCTION ............................................................. 3 2 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE .............................. 7 3 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE .............................. 75 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS ......................................... 147 5 STARTING AND OPERATING ................................................. 193 6 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES .............................................. 275 7 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE ............................................... 293 8 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES .................................................. 351 9 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE ......................................... 373 10 INDEX .................................................................... 381 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10

Upload: others

Post on 07-Jul-2020

0 views

Category:

Documents


0 download

TRANSCRIPT

Page 1: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

TABLE OF CONTENTSSECTION PAGE

1 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3

2 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7

3 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75

4 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147

5 STARTING AND OPERATING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193

6 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275

7 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293

8 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351

9 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373

10 INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

9

10

Page 2: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys
Page 3: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

INTRODUCTION

CONTENTS

� Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4

� How To Use This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4

� Warnings And Cautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5

� Vehicle Identification Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5

� Vehicle Modifications / Alterations . . . . . . . . . . . 6

1

Page 4: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

INTRODUCTIONThis manual has been prepared with the assistance ofservice and engineering specialists to acquaint you withthe operation and maintenance of your new vehicle. It issupplemented by a Warranty Information Booklet andvarious customer oriented documents. You are urged toread these publications carefully. Following the instruc-tions and recommendations in this manual will helpassure safe and enjoyable operation of your vehicle.

NOTE: After you read the manual, it should be storedin the vehicle for convenient reference and remain withthe vehicle when sold, so that the new owner will beaware of all safety warnings.

When it comes to service, remember that your dealerknows your vehicle best, has the factory-trained techni-cians and genuine Mopar� parts, and is interested inyour satisfaction.

WARNING!

Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and certainvehicle components contain or emit chemicalsknown to the State of California to cause cancer andbirth defects or other reproductive harm. In addition,certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain prod-ucts of component wear contain or emit chemicalsknown to the State of California to cause cancer andbirth defects or other reproductive harm.

HOW TO USE THIS MANUALConsult the table of contents to determine which sectioncontains the information you desire.

The detailed index, at the rear of this manual, contains acomplete listing of all subjects.

4 INTRODUCTION

Page 5: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNINGS AND CAUTIONSThis manual contains WARNINGS against operatingprocedures which could result in an accident or bodilyinjury. It also contains CAUTIONS against procedureswhich could result in damage to your vehicle. If you donot read this entire manual you may miss importantinformation. Observe all Warnings and Cautions.

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBERThe vehicle identification number (VIN) is found on astamped plate located on the left front corner of theinstrument panel pad, visible from outside of the vehiclethrough the windshield. This number also appears on theAutomobile Information Disclosure Label affixed to awindow on your vehicle. Save this label for a convenientrecord of your vehicle identification number and optionalequipment.

NOTE: It is illegal to remove the VIN plate.

INTRODUCTION 5

1

Page 6: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS / ALTERATIONS

WARNING!

Any modifications or alterations to this vehiclecould seriously affect its roadworthiness and safetyand may lead to an accident resulting in seriousinjury or death.

6 INTRODUCTION

Page 7: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

CONTENTS

� A Word About Your Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10

▫ Key-In-Ignition Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10

▫ Sentry Key Immobilizer— If Equipped . . . . . . .10

� Ignition And Steering Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13

▫ Manual Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13

▫ Automatic Transmissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13

� Illuminated Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14

▫ Vehicles Equipped With Power Door Locks . . . .14

� Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15

▫ Manual Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15

▫ Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16

▫ Child Protection Door Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19

� Remote Keyless Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20

▫ To Unlock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21

▫ To Lock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21

▫ Using The Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23

▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23

▫ Programming Additional Transmitters . . . . . . . .24

2

Page 8: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

▫ Battery Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25

� Security Alarm System — If Equipped . . . . . . . . .26

▫ To Set The Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27

▫ To Disarm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27

� Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28

▫ Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .28

▫ Auto Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29

▫ Window Lockout Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .29

▫ Sliding Rear Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30

▫ Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30

� Occupant Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30

▫ Lap/Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31

▫ Adjustable Upper Shoulder Belt Anchorage . . . .36

▫ Automatic Locking Mode (If Equipped) . . . . . .37

▫ Center Lap Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37

▫ Seat Belt Pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37

▫ Enhanced Driver Seat Belt Reminder System(BeltAlert) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38

▫ Seat Belts And Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . .39

▫ Seat Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39

▫ Driver And Right Front Passenger SupplementalRestraint System (SRS)—Airbags . . . . . . . . . . .40

▫ Passenger Airbag On/Off Switch –If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54

▫ Event Data Recorder (EDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56

▫ Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58

� Engine Break-In Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . .71

8 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 9: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

� Safety Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72

▫ Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72

▫ Safety Checks You Should Make InsideThe Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73

▫ Safety Checks You Should Make OutsideThe Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 9

2

Page 10: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYSThe double sided keys may be inserted into the lockswith either side up. The keys for your new vehicle areenclosed in a plastic bag with a bar code label affixed tothe front. The bar code can be used to order duplicatekeys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you receivedyour keys without the bag, ask your dealer to give youthe number.

NOTE: Integrated keys (key and key fob combined)must be cut by the dealer. The dealer must have cuttersthat have enough clearance for integrated keys.

Key-In-Ignition ReminderIf you open the driver’s door when the key is in theignition lock, a continuous chime will sound to remindyou to remove the key.

CAUTION!

An unlocked vehicle is an invitation to thieves.Always remove the key from the ignition and lockall the doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.

SENTRY KEY IMMOBILIZER— IF EQUIPPEDWith this system, an electronically coded ignition keysends a signal to the vehicle electronics. If the electronicsrecognizes the signal, the vehicle will start and continueto run. If the system does not recognize the signal, thevehicle will start and run for 2 seconds, then shut off.After six unsuccessful attempts at starting, the systemwill shut down until the correct key is used.

NOTE: If the key is in the ignition switch, then allbuttons on that transmitter will be disabled. The buttons

10 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 11: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

on the remaining transmitters will work. If the vehicle ismoving 5 mph or more, then all the transmitter buttonsare disabled for all keys.

NOTE: The Sentry Key Immobilizer System is notcompatible with remote starting systems. Use of thesesystems may result in vehicle starting problems and aloss of security protection. Additional Sentry Keys orMobil Speed-pass™ devices held against or immediatelyadjacent to the ignition key when starting the engine maycause vehicle starting problems. If a problem occurs,remove the Sentry Key from the key-ring and attempt tostart the vehicle again. Pagers, cell phones, walkman, etc.will have no effect on this system.

The �Security Light� will illuminate for about 3 secondswhen the ignition switch is first turned to the ONposition. If the vehicle electronics do not receive a validsignal from the ignition key, the �Security Light� will flash

continuously to signal that the vehicle has been immobi-lized. If the �Security Light� remains on during vehicleoperation, it indicates a fault in the system electronics. Ifthis option was ordered, all of the keys provided withyour new vehicle have been programmed to the vehicleelectronics.

Replacement Keys

NOTE: Only keys that have been programmed to thevehicle electronics can be used to start the vehicle. Oncea Sentry Key has been programmed to a vehicle, it cannotbe programmed to any other vehicle.

At the time of purchase, the original owner is providedwith a four digit PIN number. This number is requiredfor dealer replacement of keys. Duplication of keys maybe performed at an authorized dealer or by using theCustomer Key Programming procedure. This procedure

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 11

2

Page 12: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

consists of programming a blank key to the vehicleelectronics. A blank key is one which has never beenprogrammed and needs to be cut.

NOTE: When having the Sentry Key System serviced,bring all vehicle keys to the dealer.

Customer Key ProgrammingYou can program new keys to the system if you have twovalid keys by doing the following:

1. Insert the first valid key into the ignition and turn theignition to the ON position for at least 3 seconds but nolonger than 15 seconds. Turn the ignition back to the OFFposition and remove the first key.

2. Insert the second valid key and switch the ignition tothe ON position within 15 seconds. After 10 seconds, achime will sound and the �Security Light� will begin toflash. Turn the ignition back to the OFF position andremove the second key.

3. Insert a blank Sentry Key into the ignition and switchthe ignition to the ON position within 60 seconds ofhaving removed the second key. After 10 seconds, asingle chime will sound. The �Security Light� will stopflashing, then turn on for 3 seconds; then turn off.

The new Sentry Key has been programmed. Repeat thisprocess to program up to a total of 8 keys.

General InformationThis device complies with part 15 of FCC rules and withRS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to thefollowing conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful interference.

2. This device must accept any interference that may bereceived including interference that may cause undesiredoperation.

12 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 13: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly ap-proved by the party responsible for compliance couldvoid the user’s authority to operate the equipment.

IGNITION AND STEERING LOCKInsert the key fully, and then turn the switch to one of thefive illustrated positions. The key can be inserted orwithdrawn only in the LOCK position.

Manual TransmissionsWhen the steering wheel is in the LOCK position, thesteering and ignition systems are locked to provideantitheft protection for your vehicle. It may be difficult toturn the key from the LOCK position when starting yourvehicle. Move the steering wheel left and right whileturning the key until it turns easily. To remove the key,depress and hold the release button located between theignition switch and the instrument panel. Turn the igni-tion key to LOCK and remove the key.

Automatic TransmissionsIn the LOCK position, the steering and ignition systemsare locked to provide antitheft protection for your ve-hicle. It may be difficult to turn the key from the LOCKposition when starting your vehicle. Move the steeringwheel left and right while turning the key until it turns

Ignition Switch Positions

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 13

2

Page 14: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

easily. The key can be inserted or withdrawn only in theLOCK position. Push in on the key in the ignition lockcylinder to rotate to the LOCK position.

NOTE: The steering wheel will lock when the key isremoved, and the steering wheel is turned 115 degreesfrom center clockwise and 65 degrees counterclockwise.

NOTE: On vehicles equipped with an automatic trans-mission, the key cannot be turned to LOCK until theselector is in the PARK position. Do not attempt to pullthe shift lever out of PARK after the key is in the LOCKposition.

ILLUMINATED ENTRY

Vehicles Equipped With Power Door LocksAll interior lights will illuminate in the vehicle when thedoors are unlocked using the key fob.

The interior lights will remain on for 30 seconds after thelast door is closed, or until all doors are closed and eitherthe ignition is turned to the ON position or a key fobLOCK button is pressed.

There is also a battery saver feature that will turn theinterior lights off after 8 minutes if the ignition is OFFand a door is left open or the dimmer control is in theinterior lights ON position.Ignition Switch Positions

14 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 15: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

DOOR LOCKS

Manual Door LocksAll the doors can be “manually” locked from the insideby pushing down the door lock plunger, located on thedoor trim panel. Both front doors may be opened fromthe inside with the door lock plunger in the down orlocked position.

WARNING!

For personal security and safety in the event of anaccident, lock the vehicle doors as you drive as wellas when you park and leave the vehicle.

WARNING!

When leaving the vehicle always remove the keyfrom the ignition lock, and lock your vehicle. Do notleave children unattended in the vehicle, or withaccess to an unlocked vehicle. Unsupervised use ofvehicle equipment may cause severe personal inju-ries and death.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 15

2

Page 16: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Power Door Locks

Vehicles equipped with power door locks can be lockedor unlocked from inside by either the use of the door lockswitches located on the front doors or by pressing theLOCK or UNLOCK buttons on the Remote Keyless Entrykey fob.

16 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 17: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

As a safety feature the doors will not lock when using thedoor lock switches during the following conditions:

• The driver’s door is open while the key is in theignition.

Automatic Door LocksIf this feature is enabled, your door locks will lockautomatically when the vehicle’s speed exceeds 15 mph(24 km/h).

This feature is enabled when your vehicle is shippedfrom the assembly plant and can be disabled by using thefollowing procedure:

1. Enter your vehicle and Close all doors.

2. Fasten your seat belt (Fastening the seat belt willcancel any chiming that may confuse you during thisprogramming procedure).

3. Place the key into the ignition.

4. Within 10 seconds, cycle the key from the OFF positionto the ON position a minimum of four times; ending inthe Off position ( Do not start the engine ).

5. Within 30 seconds, press the driver’s door lock switchin the LOCK direction.

6. A single chime will be heard to indicate the feature hasbeen disabled.

7. To re-activate this feature, repeat the above steps.

8. If a chime is not heard, program mode was canceledbefore the feature could be disabled. If necessary, repeatthe above procedure.

Auto Unlock FeatureThis feature unlocks all the doors of the vehicle when anydoor is opened. The following must be met:

• The doors of the vehicle must be locked automaticallyby the Automatic Door Lock feature.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 17

2

Page 18: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• The vehicle is in P (Park) and the ignition switch is inany key position.

This feature will not operate if any of the conditionsabove are not met or following has occurred:

• Any manual operation of a door lock switch hasoccurred.

NOTE: This customer programmable feature is enabledwhen your vehicle is shipped from the assembly plant.

Auto Unlock Feature ProgrammingCustomer Programming sequence to disable or enable:

1. Enter your vehicle and close all doors.

2. Fasten your seat belt (fastening the seat belt will cancelany chiming that may be confusing during this program-ming procedure).

3. Insert the key into the ignition.

4. Within 10 seconds, cycle the key from the OFF positionto the ON position a minimum of four times; ending inthe Off position ( Do not start the engine ).

5. Within 30 seconds, press the driver’s door lock switchin the UNLOCK direction.

6. A single chime will sound to indicate the feature hasbeen changed.

7. To reactivate the feature, repeat the above steps.

8. If a chime is not heard, program mode was canceledbefore the feature could be changed. If necessary repeatthe above procedure.

18 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 19: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Child Protection Door LockTo provide a safer environment for children riding in therear seat, the rear doors of your vehicle have the child-protection door lock system.

To use the system, open each rear door and slide thecontrol UP to engage the locks and DOWN to disengagethe child-protection locks. When the system on a door isengaged, that door can only be opened by using theoutside door handle even if the inside door lock is in theunlocked position.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 19

2

Page 20: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Avoid trapping anyone in a vehicle in a collision.Remember that the rear doors can only be openedfrom the outside when the child protection locks areengaged.

NOTE: After setting the child protection door locksystem, always test the door from the inside to makecertain it is in the desired position.

NOTE: For emergency exit with the system engaged,move the door lock switch to the UNLOCK position, rolldown the window and open the door with the outsidedoor handle.

REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY

This system allows you to lock or unlock the doors oractivate the panic alarm from distances a minimum of 66feet (20 meters) using a hand held radio transmitter. Thetransmitter need not be pointed at the vehicle to activatethe system.

20 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 21: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: The line of transmission must not be blockedwith metal objects.

To unlock the doors:Press and release the UNLOCK button on the key fobonce to unlock only the driver’s door or twice to unlockall the doors. When the UNLOCK button is pressed, theilluminated entry will initiate, and the parking lights willflash on twice.

The system can be programmed to unlock all the doorsupon the first UNLOCK button press by using thefollowing procedure:

1. Press and hold the LOCK button on a programmedkey fob.

2. Continue to hold the LOCK button at least 4 seconds,but not longer than 10 seconds, then press and hold theUNLOCK button. A single chime will sound to indicatethat this feature has changed.

3. Release both buttons at the same time.

4. Test the feature while outside of the vehicle, bypressing the LOCK/UNLOCK button on the keyfob.

NOTE: Pressing the LOCK button on the keyfob whileyou are inside the vehicle will activate the SecurityAlarm. Opening a door with the Security Alarm activatedwill cause the alarm to sound. Press the UNLOCK buttonto deactivate the Security Alarm.

5. If the desired programming was not achieved or toreactivate this feature, repeat the above steps.

To lock the doors:Press and release the LOCK button on the key fob to lockall doors. If the ignition is OFF, when the doors arelocked, the parking lights will flash on once and the hornwill chirp once.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 21

2

Page 22: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Horn Chirp ProgrammingThe horn chirp feature will be shipped from the assemblyplants activated. If desired this feature can be disabled byusing the following procedure:

1. Press and hold the LOCK button on the key fob.

2. After holding the LOCK button for four seconds, alsopress the PANIC button within 6 seconds. A single chimewill sound to indicate that this feature has changed.

3. Release both buttons at the same time.

4. To reactivate this feature, repeat the above steps.

5. Test the horn chirp feature while outside of the ve-hicle, by pressing the LOCK button on the key fob withthe ignition in the OFF position and the key removed.

NOTE: Pressing the LOCK button on the keyfob, whileyou are inside the vehicle, will activate the Security

Alarm. Opening a door with the Security Alarm activatedwill cause the alarm to sound. Press the UNLOCK buttonto deactivate the Security Alarm.

6. If the desired programming was not achieved or toreactivate this feature, repeat the above steps.

Flash Lamps with Lock Programming

1. Press and hold the UNLOCK button on the key fob.

2. After holding the UNLOCK button for four seconds,also press the LOCK button within 6 seconds. A singlechime will sound to indicate that this feature haschanged.

3. Release both buttons at the same time.

4. Test the flash lamps with LOCK feature while outsideof the vehicle, by pressing the LOCK button on the keyfob with the ignition in the OFF position, and the keyremoved.

22 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 23: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: Pressing the LOCK button on the key fob, whileyou are in the vehicle, will activate the Security Alarm.Opening a door with the Security Alarm activated willcause the alarm to sound. Press the UNLOCK button todeactivate the Security Alarm.

5. If the desired programming was not achieved or toreactivate this feature, repeat the above steps.

Using the Panic AlarmTo activate the Panic mode while the ignition is OFF pressand release the PANIC button on the transmitter once.When the Panic mode is activated, the interior lights willilluminate, the headlamps and parking lights will flash,and the horn will sound.

To cancel the Panic mode press and release the PANICbutton on the transmitter a second time. Panic mode willautomatically cancel after 3 minutes or if the vehicle isstarted or exceeds 15 mph (24 km/h). During the Panic

Mode, the door locks and remote keyless entry systemswill function normally. Panic mode will not disarm thesecurity system on vehicles so equipped.

General InformationThis device complies with part 15 of FCC rules and withRS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to thefollowing conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful interference.

2. This device must accept any interference that may bereceived including interference that may cause undesiredoperation.

NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly ap-proved by the party responsible for compliance couldvoid the user’s authority to operate the equipment.

If your Remote Lock Control fails to operate from anormal distance, check for these two conditions.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 23

2

Page 24: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

1. Weak batteries in transmitter. The expected life ofbatteries is five years.

2. Closeness to a radio transmitter such as a radio stationtower, airport transmitter, military base, and some mobileor CB radios.

Programming Additional TransmittersVehicles will be shipped from the assembly plants withtwo key fob transmitters programmed only for thatvehicle. A total of eight fobs can be programmed for yourvehicle. Additional fobs can be programmed to yourvehicle through the use of a currently programmed fob.

NOTE: When entering program mode using that fob, allother programmed fobs will be erased and you will haveto reprogram them for your vehicle.

Use the following procedure to program additional keyfobs if the vehicle is not equipped with Sentry Key:

1. Enter your vehicle and close all doors.

2. Fasten your seat belt (Fastening the seatbelt will cancelany chiming that may confuse you during this program-ming procedure).

3. Place the key into the ignition.

4. Turn the ignition to the ON position ( Do not start theengine ).

5. Press and hold the UNLOCK button on the key fob.

6. After holding the UNLOCK button for four seconds,also press the PANIC button within 6 seconds.

24 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 25: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

7. When a single chime is heard release both buttons. Thechime is an indication that you have successfully enteredprogram mode. All fobs that are to be programmed mustbe done so within 60 seconds of when the chime washeard.

8. Using the fob to be programmed, press and hold boththe LOCK and UNLOCK buttons, simultaneously for 2seconds and then release.

9. Press and release the UNLOCK button a single chimewill be heard.

10. Repeat steps 8 and 9 to program up to six additionalfobs.

11. Turn the ignition to the OFF position.

12. Your vehicle will remain in program mode up to 60seconds from when the original chime was heard. After60 seconds, all programmed fobs function normally.

NOTE: If you do not have a programmed transmitter,contact your dealer for details.

Battery ReplacementThe recommended replacement battery (2 required) ) isCR2032.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 25

2

Page 26: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

1. If the key fob is equipped with a screw, remove thescrew. With the transmitter buttons facing down, use aflat blade to pry the two halves of the transmitter apart.Make sure not to damage the elastomer seal duringremoval.

2. Remove and replace the batteries. Avoid touching thenew batteries with your fingers. Skin oils may causebattery deterioration. If you touch a battery, clean it withrubbing alcohol.

3. To assemble the transmitter case, snap the two halvestogether.

NOTE: If the key fob is equipped with a screw, reinstalland tighten the screw until snug.

SECURITY ALARM SYSTEM — IF EQUIPPEDThis system monitors the vehicle doors and ignition forunauthorized operation. When the alarm is activated, thesystem provides both audible and visual signals. Thehorn will sound repeatedly for 3 minutes and the head-lights and security light in the instrument cluster willflash for an additional 15 minutes. The engine will notrun until the system is disarmed.

26 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 27: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

To Set the Alarm:The alarm will set when you use the power door locks oruse the Keyless Entry transmitter to lock the doors. Afterall the doors are locked and closed, the security light inthe instrument cluster will flash rapidly to signal that thesystem is arming. The security light in the instrumentpanel cluster will flash rapidly for about 15 seconds toindicate that the alarm is being set. After the alarm is set,the security light will flash at a slower rate to indicatethat the system is armed.

NOTE: If the security light stays on continuously duringvehicle operation, have the system checked by yourdealer.

To Disarm the System:Use the Keyless Entry transmitter to unlock the doors. Ifsomething has triggered the system in your absence, thehorn will sound three times when you unlock the doors.Check the vehicle for tampering.

The security system will also disarm, if the vehicle isstarted with a programmed Sentry Key. If an unpro-grammed Sentry Key is used to start a vehicle, the enginewill start and run for 2 seconds and then shut down.After six unsuccessful attempts at starting the engine, thesystem will shut down until the correct key is used. Toexit alarming mode, press the RKE Unlock button or startthe vehicle with a programmed Sentry Key.

The security alarm system is designed to protect yourvehicle; however, you can create conditions where thesystem will arm unexpectedly. If you remain in thevehicle and lock the doors with the transmitter, the alarmwill sound when you pull the door handle to exit.

NOTE: You may accidentally activate the security sys-tem (horn sounds and lights flash) by entering the vehiclewithout using the key fob to unlock the door(s). Thesecurity system can be disarmed with the key fob’s

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 27

2

Page 28: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

UNLOCK button or by inserting a programmed SentryKey into the ignition and turning the key to the ONposition.

WINDOWS

Power Windows

The control on the left front door has up-down switchesthat give you finger tip control of all four power win-dows. There is a single opening and closing switch on thepassenger doors for passenger window control. Thewindows will operate only when the ignition switch isturned to the ON position.

28 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 29: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Auto DownThe driver’s window switch has an Auto Down feature.Push the window switch past the first detent, release, andthe window will go down automatically. To cancel theAuto Down movement, operate the switch in either theup or down direction and release the switch.

Window Lockout SwitchThe window lockout switch on the driver’s door allowsyou to disable the window control on the other doors. Todisable the window controls on the other doors, press thewindow lock button. To enable the window controls,press the window control button again.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 29

2

Page 30: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Sliding Rear Window

A locking device in the center of the window helps toprevent entry from the rear of the vehicle. Squeeze thelock to release the window.

WIND BUFFETINGWind buffeting can be described as the perception ofpressure on the ears or a helicopter type sound in theears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with thewindows down or partially open.. This is a normaloccurrence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurswith the rear windows open, open the front and rearwindows together to minimize the buffeting.

OCCUPANT RESTRAINTSSome of the most important safety features in yourvehicle are the restraint systems. These include the frontand rear seat belts for the driver and all passengers, kneebolsters, front airbags for both the driver and frontpassenger, and if equipped left and right side curtainairbags for the driver and passengers seated next to awindow. If you will be carrying children too small foradult-size seat belts, your seat belts or the LATCH feature(refer to the Child Restraint section in this manual), canbe used to hold infant and child restraint systems.

Sliding Window Light Latch

30 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 31: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Please pay close attention to the information in thissection. It tells you how to use your restraint systemproperly to keep you and your passengers as safe aspossible.

WARNING!

In a collision, you and your passengers can suffermuch greater injuries if you are not properly buck-led up. You can strike the interior of your vehicle orother passengers, or you can be thrown out of thevehicle. Always be sure you and others in yourvehicle are buckled up properly.

Buckle up even though you are an excellent driver, evenon short trips. Someone on the road may be a poor driverand cause a collision that includes you. This can happenfar away from home or on your own street.

Research has shown that seat belts save lives, and thatthey can reduce the seriousness of injuries in a collision.Some of the worst injuries happen when people arethrown from the vehicle. Seat belts reduce the possibilityof ejection and the risk of injury caused by striking theinside of the vehicle. Everyone in a motor vehicle shouldbe belted at all times.

Lap/Shoulder BeltsAll seating positions except the front center seatingposition (with full bench seat) have combination lap/shoulder belts. The belt webbing retractor is designed tolock during very sudden stops or collisions. This featureallows the shoulder part of the belt to move freely withyou under normal conditions. But in a collision, the beltwill lock and reduce the risk of your striking the inside ofthe vehicle or being thrown out.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 31

2

Page 32: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, peopleriding in these areas are more likely to be seriouslyinjured or killed.

Do not allow people to ride in any area of yourvehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat belts.

Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat andusing a seat belt properly.

WARNING!

• Wearing a seat belt incorrectly is dangerous. Seatbelts are designed to go around the large bones ofyour body. These are the strongest parts of yourbody and can take the forces of a collision thebest. Wearing your belt in the wrong place couldmake your injuries in a collision much worse. Youmight suffer internal injuries, or you could evenslide out of part of the belt. Follow these instruc-tions to wear your seat belt safely and to keepyour passengers safe, too.

• Two people should never be belted into a singleseat belt. People belted together can crash into oneanother in an accident, hurting one another badly.Never use a lap/shoulder belt or a lap belt formore than one person, no matter what their size.

32 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 33: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Lap/Shoulder Belt Operating Instructions

1. Enter the vehicle and close the door. Sit back andadjust the seat.

2. The seat belt latch plate is above the back of the frontseat, next to your arm in the rear seat. Grasp the latch

plate and pull out the belt. Slide the latch plate up thewebbing as far as necessary to allow the belt to go aroundyour lap.

3. When the belt is long enough to fit, insert the latchplate into the buckle until you hear a “click.”

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 33

2

Page 34: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

• A belt buckled into the wrong buckle will not protectyou properly. The lap portion could ride too high on yourbody, possibly causing internal injuries. Always buckleyour belt into the buckle nearest you.• A belt that is too loose will not protect you as well. Ina sudden stop you could move too far forward, increasingthe possibility of injury. Wear your seat belt snugly.• A belt that is worn under your arm is very dangerous.Your body could strike the inside surfaces of the vehiclein a collision, increasing head and neck injury. And a beltworn under the arm can cause internal injuries. Ribsaren’t as strong as shoulder bones. Wear the belt overyour shoulder so that your strongest bones will take theforce in a collision.• A shoulder belt placed behind will not protect you frominjury during a collision. You are more likely to hit yourhead in a collision if you do not wear your shoulder belt.The lap and shoulder belt are meant to be used together.

4. Position the lap belt across your thighs, below yourabdomen. To remove slack in the lap belt portion, pull upon the shoulder belt. To loosen the lap belt if it is too tight,tilt the latch plate and pull on the lap belt. A snug beltreduces the risk of sliding under the belt in a collision.

34 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 35: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

• A lap belt worn too high can increase the risk ofinternal injury in a collision. The belt forces won’tbe at the strong hip and pelvic bones, but across yourabdomen. Always wear the lap belt as low as pos-sible and keep it snug.

• A twisted belt can’t do its job as well. In a collisionit could even cut into you. Be sure the belt is straight.If you can’t straighten a belt in your vehicle, take itto your dealer and have it fixed.

5. Position the shoulder belt on your chest so that it iscomfortable and not resting on your neck. The retractorwill withdraw any slack in the belt.

6. To release the belt, push the red button on the buckle.The belt will automatically retract to its stowed position.If necessary, slide the latch plate down the webbing toallow the belt to retract fully.

WARNING!

A frayed or torn belt could rip apart in a collisionand leave you with no protection. Inspect the beltsystem periodically, checking for cuts, frays, or looseparts. Damaged parts must be replaced immediately.Do not disassemble or modify the system. Seat beltassemblies must be replaced after a collision if theyhave been damaged (bent retractor, torn webbing,etc.).

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 35

2

Page 36: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Adjustable Upper Shoulder Belt AnchorageIn the front row outboard seats, the shoulder belt can beadjusted upward or downward to help position the beltaway from your neck. Push in on the anchorage releasebutton to release the anchorage, and then move it up ordown to the position that serves you best.

As a guide, if you are shorter than average, you willprefer a lower position, and if you are taller than average,you’ll prefer a higher position. When you release theanchorage, try to move it up or down to make sure thatit is locked in the desired position.

The adjuster has an easy up (EZ Up) feature, which willallow it to be moved up without engaging the button.

36 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 37: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Automatic Locking Mode (if equipped)To convert from the normal emergency locking mode tothe automatic locking mode, grasp the shoulder beltportion and pull all of the webbing out of the retractor.Allow some of the webbing to retract into the retractor, asthe belt retracts you will hear a clicking sound to indicatethe seat belt is now in the automatic locking mode. Oncethe automatic locking mode has been activated, you willnot be able pull the webbing back out of the retractor. Todisengage the automatic locking mode, simply allow theseat belt to retract fully into the retractor to return the seatbelt to the normal emergency locking mode.

Center Lap BeltsThe center seat position on the front seat bench has a lapbelt only. To fasten the lap belt, slide the latch plate intothe buckle until you hear a “click.” To lengthen the lapbelt, tilt the latch plate and pull. To remove slack, pull the

loose end of the webbing. Wear the lap belt snug againstthe hips. Sit back and erect in the seat, then adjust the beltas tightly as is comfortable.

Seat Belt PretensionersThe seat belts for front outboard seating positions areequipped with pretensioning devices that are designed toremove any slack from the seat belt system in the event ofa collision. These devices improve the performance of theseat belt by assuring that the belt is tight about theoccupant early in a collision. Pretensioners work for allsize occupants, including those in child restraints.

NOTE: These devices are not a substitute for proper seatbelt placement by the occupant. The seat belt still must beworn snugly and positioned properly.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 37

2

Page 38: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

The pretensioners are triggered by the Occupant Re-straint Controller (ORC). Like the airbags, the pretension-ers are single use items. After a collision that is severeenough to deploy the airbags and pretensioners, bothmust be replaced.

Enhanced Driver Seat Belt Reminder System(BeltAlert)If the driver’s seat belt has not been buckled within 60seconds of starting the vehicle and if the vehicle speed isgreater than 5 mph (8 km/h), the Enhanced WarningSystem (BeltAlert) will alert the driver to buckle their seatbelt. The driver should also instruct all other occupants tobuckle their seat belts. Once the warning is triggered, theEnhanced Warning System (BeltAlert) will continue tochime and flash the Seat Belt Warning Light for 96seconds or until the driver’s seat belt is buckled. TheEnhanced Warning System (BeltAlert) will be reactivated

if the driver’s seat belt is unbuckled for more than 10seconds and the vehicle speed is greater than 5 mph (8km/h).

The Enhanced Warning System (BeltAlert) can be en-abled or disabled by your authorized dealer or byfollowing these steps:

NOTE: The following steps must occur within the first60 seconds of the ignition switch being turned to the ONor START position. DaimlerChrysler does not recom-mend deactivating the Enhanced Warning System(BeltAlert).

1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position andbuckle the driver’s seat belt.

2. Start the engine and wait for the Seat Belt WarningLight to turn off.

38 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 39: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

3. Within 60 seconds of starting the vehicle, unbuckleand then re-buckle the driver’s seat belt at least threetimes within 10 seconds, ending with the seat beltbuckled.

4. Turn off the engine. A single chime will sound tosignify that you have successfully completed the pro-gramming.

The Enhanced Warning System (BeltAlert) can be reacti-vated by repeating this procedure.

NOTE: Although the Enhanced Warning System(BeltAlert) has been deactivated, the Seat Belt WarningLight will continue to illuminate while the driver’s seatbelt remains unbuckled.

Seat Belts and Pregnant WomenWe recommend that pregnant women use seat beltsthroughout their pregnancies. Keeping the mother safe isthe best way to keep the baby safe.

Pregnant women should wear the lap part of the beltacross the thighs and as snug against the hips as possible.Keep the belt low so that it does not come across theabdomen. That way the strong bones of the hips will takethe force if there is a collision.

Seat Belt ExtenderIf a seat belt is too short, even when fully extended, yourdealer can provide you with a seat belt extender. Thisextender should be used only if the existing belt is notlong enough. When it is not required, remove the ex-tender and store it.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 39

2

Page 40: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Using a seat belt extender when not needed canincrease the risk of injury in a collision. Only use theseat belt extender when the lap belt is not longenough when it is worn low and snug, and in therecommended seating positions. Remove and storethe extender when not needed.

Driver And Right Front Passenger SupplementalRestraint System (SRS)—Airbags

This vehicle has airbags for both the driver and rightfront passenger as a supplement to the seat belt restraintsystems. The driver’s front airbag is mounted in thesteering wheel. The passenger front airbag is mounted in

40 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 41: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

the instrument panel, above the glove compartment. Thewords SRS/AIRBAG are embossed on the airbag covers.

NOTE: The front airbags are certified to the Federalregulations that allow less forceful deployment.

The front airbags have a multistage inflator design. Thismay allow the airbag to have different rates of inflationthat are based on collision severity and occupant size.Also, the front passenger airbag is certified to the Federalregulations that define Occupant Classification (Refer to�Occupant Classification System� in this section).

This vehicle may also be equipped with window bags toprotect the driver, front, and rear passengers sitting nextto a window. If the vehicle is equipped with windowbags, they are located above the side windows. Theircovers are also labeled SRS AIRBAG.

NOTE: Airbag covers may not be obvious in the interiortrim; but they will open to allow airbag deployment.

WARNING!

• Do not put anything on or around the front airbagcovers or attempt to manually open them. You maydamage the airbags and you could be injured be-cause the airbags are no longer functional. Theseprotective covers for the airbag cushions are de-signed to open only when the airbags are inflating.

• If your vehicle is equipped with window bags, donot stack luggage or other cargo up high enoughto block the location of the window bag. The areawhere the window bag is located should remainfree from any obstructions.

• If your vehicle is equipped with window bags, donot have any accessory items installed which willalter the roof, including adding a sunroof to yourvehicle. Do not add roof racks that require perma-nent attachments (bolts or screws) for installationon the vehicle roof. Do not drill into the roof ofthe vehicle for any reason.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 41

2

Page 42: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Along with the seat belts, front airbags work with theinstrument panel knee bolsters to provide improvedprotection for the driver and front passenger. Windowbags also work with seat belts to improve occupantprotection.

The seat belts are designed to protect you in many typesof collisions. The front airbags deploy in moderate tosevere frontal collisions.

NOTE: The passenger front airbag may not deploy evenwhen the driver front airbag has if the Occupant Classi-fication System (refer to �Occupant Classification System�in this section) has determined the passenger seat isempty or is occupied by someone that is classified in the�small child� category.

If your vehicle is so equipped, the window bag on thecrash side of the vehicle is triggered in moderate tosevere side collisions. But even in collisions where the

airbags work, you need the seat belts to keep you in theright position for the airbags to protect you properly.

Here are some simple steps you can follow to minimizethe risk of harm from a deploying airbag.

1. Children 12 years and under should always ridebuckled up in a rear seat in an appropriate child restraint.

Infants in rear-facing child restraints should NEVER ridein the front seat of a vehicle with a passenger front airbag.An airbag deployment can cause severe injury or death toinfants in that position.

If a child from 1 to 12 years old must ride in the frontpassenger seat because the vehicle is crowded, move theseat as far back as possible, and use the proper childrestraint. See �Child Restraint� in this section.

You should read the instructions provided with yourchild restraint to make sure that you are using it properly.

42 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 43: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

2. All occupants should use their lap and shoulder beltsproperly.

3. The driver and front passenger seats should be movedback as far as practical to allow the airbag room to inflate.

4. If your vehicle has window bags, do not lean againstthe door or window, airbags will inflate forcefully intothe space between you and the door.

5. If the airbag system in this vehicle needs to bemodified to accommodate a disabled person, contact theCustomer Center. Phone numbers are provided in the �IfYou Need Customer Assistance� section later in thisowner’s manual.

WARNING!

• Relying on the airbags alone could lead to moresevere injuries in a collision. The airbags workwith your seat belt to restrain you properly. Insome collisions the airbags won’t deploy at all.Always wear your seat belts even though youhave airbags.

• Being too close to the steering wheel or instru-ment panel during airbag deployment could causeserious injury. Airbags need room to inflate. Sitback, comfortably extending your arms to reachthe steering wheel or instrument panel.

• If the vehicle has window bags, they also needroom to inflate. Do not lean against the door orwindow. Sit upright in the center of the seat.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 43

2

Page 44: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Air Bag System ComponentsThe airbag system consists of the following:

• Occupant Restraint Controller

• Side Remote Acceleration Sensors (If Equipped)

• Airbag Warning Light

• Driver Airbag

• Passenger Airbag

• Window Bags above Side Windows (If Equipped)

• Steering Wheel and Column

• Instrument Panel

• Interconnecting Wiring

• Knee Impact Bolsters

• Front Acceleration Sensors

• Driver and Front Passenger Seat Belt Pretensioners

• Occupant Classification System (OCS) for the FrontPassenger Seat

− Occupant Classification Module

− Passenger Airbag Disable (PAD) Indicator Light

− Weight Sensors

How the Airbag System Works

• The Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC) determinesif a frontal collision is severe enough to require theairbags to inflate. The front airbag inflators are de-signed to provide different rates of airbag inflationfrom direction provided by the ORC. The ORC mayalso modify the rate of inflation based on the occupantsize provided by the Occupant Classification Module.The ORC will not detect roll over.

44 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 45: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

The ORC also monitors the readiness of the electronicparts of the system whenever the ignition switch is inthe START or RUN positions. These include all of theitems listed above except the steering wheel andcolumn, and knee bolsters. If the key is in the OFFposition, in the ACC position, or not in the ignition,the airbags are not on and will not inflate.

During a moderate-to-severe rear impact the ORC maydeploy the seat belt pretensioners alone.

Also, the ORC turns on the AIRBAG warninglight and PAD indicator light in the instrumentpanel for 6 to 8 seconds for a self-check whenthe ignition is first turned on. After the self-

check, the AIRBAG warning light will turn off. The PADindicator light will function normally (Refer to �Passen-ger Airbag Disable (PAD) Indicator Light� in this section).If the ORC detects a malfunction in any part of thesystem, it turns on the AIRBAG warning light either

momentarily or continuously. A single chime will soundif the light comes on again after initial start up.

WARNING!

Ignoring the AIRBAG warning light in your instru-ment panel could mean you won’t have the airbagsto protect you in a collision. If the light does notcome on, stays on after you start the vehicle, or if itcomes on as you drive, have the airbag systemchecked right away.

• The Occupant Classification System (OCS) is part ofa Federally regulated safety system required for thisvehicle. It is designed to turn off the front passengerairbag in the unlikely event that a rear-facing infantseat is in the front passenger seat.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 45

2

Page 46: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: Children 12 years and under should always ridebuckled up in a rear seat in an appropriate child restraint.

• The Passenger Airbag Disable (PAD) Indicator Light(an amber light located in the center of the instrumentpanel) tells the driver and front passenger when thefront passenger airbag is turned off.

If the passenger frontal air bag is automatically turnedoff by the OCS, or by using the manual on/off switch(on vehicles so equipped), the PAD Indicator lampiluminates the passenger frontal airbag symbol andthe word �OFF� to show that the passenger airbag willnot inflate during a collision requiring airbags.

When the right front passenger seat is empty or whenvery light objects are placed on the seat, the passenger airbag will not inflate even though the Passenger AirbagDisable (PAD) indicator lamp is not illuminated.

The PAD indictor light should not be illuminated whenteenagers, most children in a forward facing child re-straint or booster seats, most children that can properlywear the vehicle’s seat belt, and when an adult passengeris properly seated in the front passenger seat. In this case,the air bag is ready to be inflated if a collision requiringan airbag occurs.

46 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 47: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

For almost all properly installed rear facing child re-straints, the PAD indicator light will be illuminatedindicating that the front passenger airbag is turned offand will not inflate. If the PAD indicator light is notilluminated, DO NOT assume the air bag is turned offand move the child restraint to the second row of seats (ifequipped). A deploying passenger air bag can causedeath or serious injury to a child in a rear facing infantseat. For vehicles with a manual on/off switch, thepassenger frontal airbag can be manually turned off. Seesection on how to use the switch later in this section.

NOTE: Even though this vehicle is equipped with anoccupant classification system, children 12 years andunder should always ride buckled up in a rear seat (ifequipped) in an appropriate child restraint (see sectionon child restraints).

Front PassengerSeat Occupant

Passenger Air-bag Disable

(PAD) IndicatorLight

Airbag Status

Adult OFF ONGrocery Bags,

Heavy Briefcasesand Other Rela-tively Light Ob-

jects

ON OFF

Empty or VerySmall Objects OFF* OFF

* Since the system senses weight, some small objectswill turn the PAD Indicator Light on.

The OCS classifies an occupant using weight sensorsmounted in the base of the front passenger seat. Objectshanging on the seat or other passengers pushing downon the seat will also be sensed. The weight of an adultwill cause the system to turn the airbag on. In this case,

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 47

2

Page 48: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

the OCS has classified the occupant of the seat as anadult. An adult occupant needs to sit in a normal position(with their feet on or near the floor) in order to beproperly classified. Reclining the seat back too far maychange how an occupant is classified by the OCS.

Drivers and adult passengers should verify that the PADIndicator Light is not illuminated when an adult is ridingin the front passenger seat. If an adult occupant’s weightis transferred to another part of the vehicle (like the dooror instrument panel), the weight sensors in the seat maynot properly classify the occupant. Objects lodged underthe seat or between the seat and the center console canprevent the occupant’s weight from being measuredproperly and may result in the occupant being improp-erly classified. Ensure that the front passenger seat backdoes not touch anything placed behind the front passen-ger seat because this can also affect occupant classifica-tion.

If the front passenger seat is damaged in any way, itshould only be serviced by an authorized dealer. If theseat is removed (or even if the seat attachment bolts areloosened or tightened in any way), take the vehicle to anauthorized dealer.

If there is a fault present in the OCS, the Airbag WarningLight (a red light located in the center of the instrumentcluster directly in front of the driver) will be turned on.This indicates that you should take the vehicle to anauthorized dealer. The Airbag Warning Light is turned onwhenever there is fault that can affect the operation of theairbag system. If there is a fault present in the OCS, boththe PAD Indicator Light and the Airbag Warning Lightare illuminated to show that the passenger airbag isturned off until the fault is cleared. If an object is lodgedunder the seat and interferes with operation of the weightsensors, a fault will occur which turns on both the PAD

48 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 49: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Indicator Light and the Airbag Warning Light. Once thelodged object is removed, the fault will be automaticallycleared after a short period of time.

• The Driver and Passenger Airbag/Inflator Units arelocated in the center of the steering wheel and the rightside of the instrument panel. When the ORC detects acollision requiring the airbags, it signals the inflatorunits. A large quantity of nontoxic gas is generated toinflate the front airbags. Different airbag inflation ratesmay be possible based on collision severity and occu-pant size. The steering wheel hub trim cover and theupper right side of the instrument panel separate andfold out of the way as the bags inflate to their full size.The bags fully inflate in about 50 - 70 milliseconds.This is about half of the time it takes to blink your eyes.The bags then quickly deflate while helping to restrainthe driver and front passenger. The driver’s frontairbag gas is vented through vent holes in the sides ofthe airbag. The passenger’s front airbag gas is vented

through vent holes in the sides of the airbag. In thisway the airbags do not interfere with your control ofthe vehicle.

• The Occupant Classification Module (OCM) is lo-cated beneath the front passenger seat. The OCMclassifies the occupant into categories based on themeasurements made by the seat weight sensors. TheOCM communicates with the Occupant Restraint Con-troller (ORC). The ORC uses the occupant category todetermine whether the front passenger airbag shouldbe turned off. It also determines the rate of airbaginflation during a collision.

• The Passenger Airbag Disabled (PAD) IndicatorLight indicates to the driver and passenger when theairbag is turned OFF. In the presence of a properlyseated occupant, when the PAD indicator light isilluminated, the airbag is OFF. Also, when the Occu-pant Classification System detects either an empty seat

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 49

2

Page 50: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

or a weight less than the predetermined threshold, theORC will not illuminate the PAD indicator light eventhough the airbag is turned OFF.

• Your vehicle has four Weight Sensors located withinthe seat structure or between the seat tracks andcushion frame. The weight sensors measure appliedweight and transfers that information to the OCM.

• The Side Impact SRS Window Bags are designed toactivate only in certain side collisions. When the ORC(with side impact option) detects a collision requiringthe window bags to inflate, it signals the inflators onthe crash side of the vehicle. A quantity of nontoxic gasis generated to inflate the window bag. The inflatingwindow bag pushes the outside edge of the headlinerout of the way and covers the window. The airbagforcefully inflates in about one quarter of the time ittakes to blink your eye. Make sure you are seated andbelted properly and do not position items in the area

where the window bag inflates. This especially appliesto children. The window bag is only about 3-1/2inches (9 cm) thick when it is inflated.

• The Knee Impact Bolsters help protect the knees ofthe driver and the front passenger, and position every-one for the best interaction with the front airbag.

• The front passenger seat assembly contains criticalcomponents that affect the front passenger airbagdeployment. Correctly functioning front passengerseat components are critical for the Occupant Classifi-cation System (OCS) to properly classify the frontpassenger and calculate the proper airbag deploy-ment. Do not make any modifications to the frontpassenger seat components, assembly, or to the seatcover. The following requirements must be strictlyadhered to:

• Do not modify the front passenger seat assembly orcomponents in any way.

50 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 51: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• Do not modify the front seat center console or centerposition seat in any way.

• Do not use prior or future model year seat covers notdesignated for the specific model being repaired. Al-ways use the correct seat cover specified for thevehicle.

• Do not replace the seat cover with an aftermarket seatcover. Do not add a secondary seat cover other thanthose approved by DaimlerChrysler/Mopar.�

• At no time should any supplemental restraint system(SRS) component or SRS related component or fas-tener be modified or replaced with any part exceptthose which are approved by DaimlerChrysler/Mopar�.

WARNING!

Unapproved modifications or service procedures tothe front passenger seat assembly, its related compo-nents, or seat cover may inadvertently change theairbag deployment in case of a frontal crash. Thiscould result in death or serious injury to the frontseat passenger if the vehicle is involved in an acci-dent. A modified vehicle may not comply withrequired Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards(FMVSS).

If A Deployment OccursThe airbag system is designed to deploy the airbagswhen the impact sensors detect a moderate-to-severefrontal collision, to help restrain the driver and frontpassenger, and then immediately deflate.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 51

2

Page 52: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: A frontal collision that is not severe enough toneed airbag protection will not activate the system. Thisdoes not mean something is wrong with the airbagsystem.

If you do have a collision which deploys the airbags, anyor all of the following may occur:

• The nylon airbag material may sometimes cause abra-sions and/or skin reddening to the driver and frontpassenger as the airbags deploy and unfold. Theabrasions are similar to friction rope burns or thoseyou might get sliding along a carpet or gymnasiumfloor. They are not caused by contact with chemicals.They are not permanent and normally heal quickly.However, if you haven’t healed significantly within afew days, or if you have any blistering, see your doctorimmediately. As the airbags deflate you may see somesmoke-like particles. The particles are a normal by-product of the process that generates the nontoxic gas

used for airbag inflation. These airborne particles mayirritate the skin, eyes, nose, or throat. If you have skinor eye irritation, rinse the area with cool water. Fornose or throat irritation, move to fresh air. If theirritation continues, see your doctor. If these particlessettle on your clothing, follow the garment manufac-turer’s instructions for cleaning.

• It is not advisable to drive your vehicle after theairbags have deployed. If you are involved in anothercollision, the airbags will not be in place to protect you.

52 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 53: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Deployed airbags and seat belt pretensioners cannotprotect you in another collision. Have the airbags,seat belt pretensioners, and the front passenger seatbelt retractor assembly, replaced by an authorizeddealer as soon as possible. Also, have the OccupantClassification System serviced as well.

Maintaining Your Airbag System

WARNING!

• Modifications to any part of the airbag system could cause it to fail when youneed it. You could be injured if the airbag system is not there to protect you. Donot modify the components or wiring, including adding any kind of badges orstickers to the steering wheel hub trim cover or the upper right side of theinstrument panel. Do not modify the front bumper, vehicle body structure, oradd aftermarket side steps or running boards.

• Do not attempt to modify any part of your advanced airbag system. The airbagmay inflate accidentally or may not function properly if modifications aremade. Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer for any advanced airbag systemservice. If your seat including your trim cover and cushion needs to be servicedin any way (including removal or loosening/tightening of seat attachmentbolts), take the vehicle to your authorized dealer. Only manufacturer approvedseat accessories may be used. If it is necessary to modify an advanced airbagsystem for persons with disabilities, contact your authorized dealer.

• Do not place or hang any items such as add-on video players on the right frontpassenger seat back. The additional weight may cause the Occupant Classifi-cation System to be unable to correctly classify the right front occupant. Thiscould allow the passenger frontal airbag to inflate when it is not desired.

• You need proper knee impact protection in a collision. Do not mount or locateany aftermarket equipment on or behind the knee bolsters.

• It is dangerous to try to repair any part of the airbag system yourself. Be sureto tell anyone who works on your vehicle that it has an airbag system.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 53

2

Page 54: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Enhanced Accident Response SystemIf the airbags deploy after an impact and the electricalsystem remains functional, vehicles equipped withpower door locks will unlock automatically. In addition,approximately 5 seconds after the vehicle has stoppedmoving, the interior lights will light until the ignitionswitch is turned off.

Airbag LightYou will want to have the airbags ready toinflate for your protection in an impact. Whilethe airbag system is designed to be mainte-nance free, if any of the following occurs, have

an authorized dealer service the system promptly:

• The airbag light does not come on or flickers duringthe 6 to 8 seconds when the ignition switch is firstturned on.

• The light remains on or flickers after the 6 to 8 secondinterval.

• The light flickers or comes on and remains on whiledriving.

NOTE: If the speedometer, tachometer or any enginerelated gauges are not working, the airbag control mod-ule may also be disabled. The airbags may not be readyto inflate for your protection. Promptly check fuse blockfor blown fuses. Refer to the label located on the inside ofthe fuse block cover for the proper airbag fuses. See yourdealer if the fuse is good.

Passenger Airbag On/Off Switch – If EquippedThe passenger front airbag is to be turned off only if thepassenger:

• is an infant (less than 1 year old) who must ride in thefront seat because there is no rear seat, because the rearseat is too small for a rear-facing infant restraint orbecause the infant has a medical condition whichmakes it necessary for the driver to be able to see theinfant,

54 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 55: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• is a child, age 1 to 12 who must ride in the front seatbecause there is no rear seat, because there is no rearseat position available, or because the child has amedical condition which makes it necessary for thedriver to be able to see the child,

• has a medical condition which makes passenger airbaginflation (deployment) a greater risk for the passengerthan the risk of hitting the dashboard (instrumentpanel) or windshield in a crash.

WARNING!

Whenever an airbag is turned off, even a lap/shoulder belted passenger may hit their head, neck,or chest on the dashboard (instrument panel) orwindshield in a crash. This may result in seriousinjury or death.

NOTE: The Passenger Airbag On/Off Switch is notavailable in the Quad Cab.

To Shut Off the Passenger Frontal Airbag

Place the ignition key in the Passenger Airbag On/OffSwitch, push the key in and turn clockwise, and remove

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 55

2

Page 56: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

the key from the switch. This will shut off the passengerfrontal airbag. The passenger frontal airbag symbol andthe word “OFF” on the passenger airbag disable (PAD)lamp will illuminate when the ignition switch is turnedto the ON position.

To Turn On the Passenger Frontal Airbag

Place the ignition key in the Passenger Airbag On/OffSwitch, push the key in and turn counterclockwise, andremove the key from the switch. This will turn On thepassenger frontal airbag. The passenger airbag disable(PAD) lamp will now be Off when the ignition switch isturned to the ON position.

Event Data Recorder (EDR)In the event of an airbag deployment, your vehicle isdesigned to record up to 2-seconds of specific vehicledata parameters (see list below) in an event data recorderprior to the moment of airbag deployment. Please notethat such data are ONLY recorded if an airbag deploys,

and are otherwise unavailable. In conjunction with otherdata gathered during a complete accident investigation,the electronic data may be used by DaimlerChryslerCorporation and others to learn more about the possiblecauses of crashes and associated injuries in order toassess and improve vehicle performance. In addition tocrash investigations initiated by DaimlerChrysler Corpo-ration, such investigations may be requested by custom-ers, insurance carriers, government officials, and profes-sional crash researchers, such as those associated withuniversities, and with hospital and insurance organiza-tions.

In the event that an investigation is undertaken byDaimlerChrysler Corporation (regardless of initiative),the company or its designated representative will firstobtain permission of the appropriate custodial entity forthe vehicle (usually the vehicle owner or lessee) beforeaccessing the electronic data stored, unless ordered todownload data by a court with legal jurisdiction (i.e.,

56 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 57: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

pursuant to a warrant). A copy of the data will beprovided to the custodial entity upon request. Generaldata that does not identify particular vehicles or crashesmay be released for incorporation in aggregate crashdatabases, such as those maintained by the US govern-ment and various states. Data of a potentially sensitivenature, such as would identify a particular driver, ve-hicle, or crash, will be treated confidentially. Confidentialdata will not be disclosed by DaimlerChrysler Corpora-tion to any third party except when:

1. Used for research purposes, such as to match data witha particular crash record in an aggregate database, providedconfidentiality of personal data is thereafter preserved

2. Used in defense of litigation involving aDaimlerChrysler Corporation product

3. Requested by police under a legal warrant

4. Otherwise required by law

Data Parameters that May Be Recorded:

• Diagnostic trouble code(s) and warning lamp statusfor electronically-controlled safety systems, includingthe airbag system

• Airbag disable lamp status (if equipped)

• �Time� of airbag deployment (in terms of ignitioncycles and vehicle mileage)

• Airbag deployment level (if applicable)

• Seatbelt status

• Brake status (service and parking brakes)

• Accelerator status (including vehicle speed)

• Engine control status (including engine speed)

• Cruise control status

• Traction/stability control status

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 57

2

Page 58: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Child RestraintEveryone in your vehicle needs to be buckled up all thetime - babies and children, too. Every state in the UnitedStates and all Canadian provinces require that smallchildren ride in proper restraint systems. This is the law,and you can be prosecuted for ignoring it. Children 12years and under should ride properly buckled up in arear seat, if available. According to crash statistics, chil-dren are safer when properly restrained in the rear seatsrather than in the front.

There are different sizes and types of restraints forchildren from newborn size to the child almost largeenough for an adult seat belt. Always check the child seatowner’s manual to ensure you have the right seat foryour child. Use the restraint that is correct for your child:

Infants and Small Children

• Safety experts recommend that children riderearward-facing in the vehicle until they are at leastone year old and weigh at least 20 lbs (9 kg). Two typesof child restraints can be used rearward facing: infantcarriers and �convertible� child seats.

• The infant carrier is only used rearward-facing in thevehicle. It is recommended for children who weigh upto about 20 lbs (9 kg). �Convertible� child seats can beused either rearward-facing or forward-facing in thevehicle. Convertible child seats often have a higherweight limit in the rearward-facing direction thaninfant carriers do, so they can be used rearward-facingby children who weigh more than 20 lbs (9 kg) but areless than one year old. Both types of child restraints areheld in the vehicle by the seatbelt or the LATCH childrestraint anchorage system. (See the LATCH - ChildSeat Anchorage System section.)

58 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 59: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• Rearward-facing child seats must NEVER be used inthe front seat of a vehicle with a front passenger airbagthat does not have a switch to turn the airbag Off. Anairbag deployment could cause severe injury or deathto infants in this position.

Older Children and Child Restraints

• Children who weigh more than 20 lbs (9 kg) and whoare older than one year can ride forward-facing in thevehicle. Forward-facing child seats and convertiblechild seats used in the forward-facing direction are forchildren who weigh 20 to 40 lbs (9 to 18 kg), and areolder than one year old. These child seats are also heldin the vehicle by the seatbelt or the LATCH childrestraint anchorage system. (See the LATCH - ChildSeat Anchorage System section.)

• The belt-positioning booster seat is for children weigh-ing more than 40 lbs (18 kg), but who are still too smallto fit the vehicle’s seat belts properly. If the child

cannot sit with knees bent over the seat cushion whilethe child’s back is against the seatback, they need abelt-positioning booster seat. The child and boosterseat are held in the vehicle by the lap/shoulder belt.

Children Too Large for Booster Seats

• Children who are large enough to wear the shoulderbelt comfortably, and whose legs are long enough tobend over the front of the seat when their back isagainst the seat back should use the lap/shoulder beltin a rear seat.

• Make sure that the child is upright in the seat.

• The lap portion should be low on the hips and as snugas possible.

• Check belt fit periodically. A child’s squirming orslouching can move the belt out of position.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 59

2

Page 60: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• If the shoulder belt contacts the face or neck, move thechild closer to the center of the vehicle. Never allow achild to put the shoulder belt under an arm.

For additional information, refer to www.seatcheck.org.

WARNING!

• Improper installation can lead to failure of aninfant or child restraint. It could come loose in acollision. The child could be badly injured orkilled. Follow the manufacturer’s directions ex-actly when installing an infant or child restraint.

• A rearward facing infant restraint should only beused in a rear seat of a vehicle that does not havean airbag off switch. A rearward facing infantrestraint in the front seat may be struck by adeploying passenger airbag which may cause se-vere or fatal to the infant.

Here are some tips for getting the most out of your childrestraint:

• Before buying any restraint system, make sure that ithas a label certifying that it meets all applicable SafetyStandards. The manufacturer recommends that youtry a child restraint in the vehicle seats where you willuse it before you buy it.

• The restraint must be appropriate for your child’sweight and height. Check the label on the restraint forweight and height limits.

• Carefully follow the instructions that come with therestraint. If you install the restraint improperly, it maynot work when you need it.

• The Club Cab first and Club/Quad Cab second rowoutside seating positions have cinching latch plates.These are designed to keep the lap portion tightaround the child restraint so that it is not necessary to

60 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 61: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

use a locking clip. If the seat belt has a cinching latchplate, pulling up on the shoulder portion of thelap/shoulder belt will tighten the belt. The cinchinglatch plate will keep the belt tight, however, any seatbelt system will loosen with time, so check the beltoccasionally and pull it tight if necessary.

• Buckle the child into the restraint exactly as themanufacturer’s instructions tell you.

• When your child restraint is not in use, secure it in thevehicle with the seat belt or remove it from the vehicle.Do not leave it loose in the vehicle. In a sudden stop orcollision, it could strike the occupants or seat backsand cause serious personal injury.

LATCH - Child Seat Anchorage System (LowerAnchors and Tether for CHildren)Each vehicle is equipped with the child restraint anchor-age system called LATCH, which stands for LowerAnchors and Tethers for CHildren. The LATCH system

provides for the installation of the child restraint withoutusing the vehicle’s seat belts, instead securing the childrestraint using lower anchorages and upper tether strapsfrom the child restraint to the vehicle structure. LATCH-compatible child restraint systems are now available.However, because the lower anchorages are to be intro-duced over a period of years, child restraint systemshaving attachments for those anchorages will continue toalso have features for installation using the vehicle’s seatbelts. Child restraints having tether straps and hooks forconnection to the top tether anchorages have been avail-able for some time. For some older child restraints, manychild restraint manufacturers offer add-on tether strapkits or retro-fit kits. You are urged to take advantage of allthe available attachments provided with your child re-straint in any vehicle.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 61

2

Page 62: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Club Cab

• The Club Cab front and rear right (if equipped with arear seat) passenger seating positions have loweranchorages for LATCH equipped child restraints.

Quad Cab

• The Quad Cab second row seat has lower anchoragesthat are capable of accommodating LATCH-compatible child seats having flexible, webbing-mounted lower attachments at all three seating posi-tions. Child seats with fixed lower attachments mustbe installed in the outboard positions only. Regardlessof the specific type of lower attachment, NEVER installLATCH compatible child seats such that two seatsshare a common lower anchorage. If you are installingLATCH-compatible child restraints in adjacent rearseating positions, you can use the LATCH anchors or

the vehicle’s seat belt for the outboard position, butyou must use the vehicle’s seat belt at the centerposition.

If your child restraints are not LATCH compatible, youcan only install the child restraints using the vehicle’sseat belts. Please refer to the next section for typicalinstallation instructions.

62 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 63: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Installing the LATCH-Compatible Child RestraintSystemWe urge that you carefully follow the directions of themanufacturer when installing your child restraint. Not allchild restraint systems will be installed as described here.Again, carefully follow the installation instructions thatwere provided with the child restraint system. The rear

seat lower anchorages are round bars, located at the rearof the seat cushion where it meets the seat back, and arejust visible when you lean into the vehicle to install thechild restraint. You will easily feel them if you run yourfinger along the intersection of the seatback and seatcushion surfaces. In addition, there are tether strapanchorages each LATCH seating position (see section onChild Restraint Tether Anchor). Many, but not all re-straint systems will be equipped with separate straps oneach side, with each having a hook or connector forattachment to the lower anchorage and a means ofadjusting the tension in the strap. Forward-facing toddlerrestraints and some rear-facing infant restraints will alsobe equipped with a tether strap, a hook for attachment tothe tether strap anchorage and a means of adjusting thetension of the strap. You will first loosen the adjusters onthe lower straps and on the tether strap so that you canmore easily attach the hooks or connectors to the vehicleanchorages. Next attach the lower hooks or connectors

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 63

2

Page 64: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

over the top of the anchorage bars, pushing aside the seatcover material. Then attach the tether strap to the anchor-age located on the back of the seat, being careful to routethe tether strap to provide the most direct path betweenthe anchor and the child restraint. If your vehicle isequipped with adjustable rear head restraints, raise thehead restraint and, route the tether strap under the headrestraint and between the two posts. Finally, tighten allthree straps as you push the child restraint rearward anddownward into the seat, removing slack in the strapsaccording to the child restraint manufacturer’s instruc-tions.

NOTE: When using the LATCH attaching system toinstall a child restraint, please ensure that all seat beltsnot being used for occupant restraints are stowed and outof reach of children. It is recommended that beforeinstalling the child restraint, buckle the seat belt so theseat belt is tucked behind the child restraint and out ofreach. If the buckled seat belt interferes with the child

restraint installation, instead of tucking the seat beltbehind the child restraint, route the seat belt through thechild restraint belt path and then buckle it. This shouldstow the seat belt out of the reach of an inquisitive child.Remind all children in the vehicle that the seat belts arenot toys and should not be played with, and never leaveyour child unattended in the vehicle.

WARNING!

Improper installation of a child restraint to theLATCH anchorages can lead to failure of an infant orchild restraint. The child could be badly injured orkilled. Follow the manufacturer’s directions exactlywhen installing an infant or child restraint.

64 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 65: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Installing Child Restraints Using the Vehicle SeatBeltThe passenger seat belts are equipped with either cinch-ing latch plates or automatic locking retractors, which aredesigned to keep the lap portion tight around the childrestraint so that it should not be necessary to use alocking clip. If the seat belt has a cinching latch plate,pulling up on the shoulder portion of the lap/shoulderbelt will tighten the belt. The cinching latch plate willkeep the belt tight; however, any seat belt system willloosen with time, so check the belt occasionally and pullit tight if necessary. If the seat belt has an automaticlocking retractor, it will have a distinctive label. Pull thebelt from the retractor until there is enough to allow youto pass through the child restraint and slide the latchplate into the buckle. Then, pull the belt until it is allextracted from the retractor. Allow the belt to return tothe retractor, pulling on the excess webbing to tighten thelap portion about the child restraint. For automatic

locking retractor seat belts, refer to �Automatic LockingMode� earlier in this section. If you have trouble tighten-ing the lap/shoulder belt on the child restraint becausethe buckle or latch plate is too close to the belt pathopening on the restraint, follow these steps. If the buckleis webbing mounted, disconnect the latch plate from thebuckle and twist the short buckle-end belt to shorten it.Insert the latch plate into the buckle with the releasebutton facing out. If the belt still can’t be tightened, thebuckle is not webbing mounted, or if by pulling andpushing on the restraint loosens the belt, you may needto do something more. Disconnect the latch plate fromthe buckle, turn the latch plate around, and insert thelatch plate into the buckle again. If you still can’t makethe child restraint secure, try a different seating positionor use the locking clip provided with your child restraint.See the section �Child Restraint Tether Anchor� to com-plete the child seat installation.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 65

2

Page 66: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Child Restraint Tether AnchorThe Club Cab model has two routing strapslocated behind each of the rear outboard seat-ing positions. The tether anchor itself is locatedin the center of vehicle, in between the two

seating positions. The front outboard passenger seatingposition is also equipped with a child tether anchorage,located at the base of the front seat back. When there is arear seat delete option, the tether anchorage located onthe cab back panel is designed to be used for the frontseat center seating position. The Quad cab model hasthree anchorages located behind each of the rear seatingpositions (rear left, rear center, and rear right).

WARNING!

With a child restraint installed in the rear driver orpassenger side locations, use care when adjustingthe front seat(s) rearward, to avoid the front seatback coming in contact with the belted child directlybehind the seat. The child could be injured.

WARNING!

Improper installation can lead to failure of an infantor child restraint. It could come loose in a collision.The child could be seriously injured or killed. Makesure the child restraint tether strap is always routedthrough the proper anchor strap inner loop.

66 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 67: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Tether Strap at the Front Passenger Seat (Club Cab)

1. Route the child restraint tether strap up and over thefront passenger seat back and under the head restraint.

2. Connect the tether strap to the lower anchor.

3. Remove the slack in the tether strap so that it is pulledtight.

Tether Straps at the Rear Passenger Seat (Club Cab)

1. Route the child restraint tether strap through therouting loop, located directly behind the child restraint.The routing loops are located behind the flip-down dooron the cab back panel (padded bolster).

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 67

2

Page 68: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

2. Route the tether strap across to the center tetheranchorage. The center tether is located behind the slidedoor in the center of the vehicle, between the two seatingpositions.

3. Remove the slack in the tether strap so that the anchorstrap is pulled tight.

68 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 69: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Tether Straps at the Rear Passenger Seat (Quad Cab)

1. Route the child restraint tether strap under the headrestraint for the outboard seating positions, and thenthrough the anchor strap outer loop (webbing materialloop), located directly behind the child restraint.

2. Route the tether strap across to the nearest installedanchor strap, and attach the tether strap hook to theanchor strap inner metal ring.

3. Remove the slack in the tether strap so that bothanchor straps are pulled tight.

NOTE: Two Anchors must be used for any of the threeseating positions.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 69

2

Page 70: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Multiple Child Restraint Quad Cab

70 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 71: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

An incorrectly anchored tether strap could lead toseat failure and injury to the child. In a collision, theseat could come loose and allow the child to crashinto the inside of the vehicle or other passengers, oreven be thrown from the vehicle. Use only theanchor positions directly behind the child restraintto secure a child restraint top tether strap. See yourdealer for help if necessary.

Transporting PetsAirbags deploying in the front seat could harm your pet.An unrestrained pet will be thrown about and possiblyinjured, or injure a passenger during panic braking or ina collision. Pets should be restrained in the rear seat inpet harnesses or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts.

ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONSA long break-in period is not required for the engine inyour new vehicle. Drive moderately during the first 300miles (500 km). After the initial 60 miles (100 km), speedsup to 50 or 55 mph (80 or 90 km/h) are desirable. Whilecruising, brief full-throttle acceleration, within the limitsof local traffic laws, contributes to a good break-in.

Avoid wide open throttle acceleration in low gear.

The engine oil installed in the engine at the factory is ahigh-quality, energy-conserving type lubricant. Oilchanges should be consistent with anticipated climateconditions under which vehicle operations will occur.The recommended viscosity and quality grades areshown in Section 7.

NON-DETERGENT OR STRAIGHT MINERAL OILSMUST NEVER BE USED.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 71

2

Page 72: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

A new engine may consume some oil during its first fewthousand miles of operation. This is a normal part of thebreak-in and is not an indication of difficulty.

SAFETY TIPS

Exhaust System

WARNING!

Exhaust gases contain carbon monoxide, an ex-tremely toxic gas that by itself is colorless andodorless. To avoid inhaling these gases, the follow-ing precautions should be observed:

• Do not run the engine in a closed garage or in confinedareas any longer than needed to move your vehicle inor out of the area.

• It may be necessary to sit in a parked vehicle with theengine running for more than a short period. If so,adjust your climate control system to force outside airinto the vehicle. Set the blower at high speed and thecontrols in any position except OFF or RECIRC.

• The best protection against carbon monoxide entryinto the vehicle body is a properly maintained engineexhaust system.

Be aware of changes in the sound of the exhaust system;exhaust fumes detected inside the vehicle; or damage tothe underside or rear of the vehicle. Have a competentmechanic inspect the complete exhaust system and adja-cent body areas for broken, damaged, deteriorated ormispositioned parts. Open seams or loose connectionscould permit exhaust fumes to seep into the passengercompartment. In addition, inspect the exhaust systemeach time the vehicle is raised for lubrication or oilchange. Replace or adjust as required.

72 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 73: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Safety Checks You Should Make Inside TheVehicle

Seat BeltsInspect the belt system periodically, checking for cuts,frays and loose parts. Damaged parts must be replacedimmediately. Do not disassemble or modify the system.

Seat belt assemblies must be replaced after an accident ifthey have been damaged (bent retractor, torn webbing,etc.). If there is any question regarding belt or retractorcondition, replace the belt.

DefrostersCheck operation by selecting the defrost mode and placethe blower control on high speed. You can feel the airdirected against the windshield.

Safety Checks You Should Make Outside TheVehicle:

TiresExamine tires for tread wear or uneven wear patterns.Check for stones, nails, glass or other objects lodged inthe tread.

Inspect for tread cuts or sidewall cracks. Check wheelnuts for tightness and tires for proper pressure.

LightsHave someone observe the operation of exterior lights asyou turn them on. Check turn signal and high beamindicator lights on the instrument panel.

Door LatchesCheck for positive closing, latching and locking.

THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 73

2

Page 74: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Fluid LeaksCheck the area under vehicle after overnight parking forfuel, water, oil, or other fluid leaks. Also, if gasolinefumes are detected, the cause should be located andcorrected.

74 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 75: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

CONTENTS

� Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79

▫ Inside Day/Night Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79

▫ Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped . . . .80

▫ Outside Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80

▫ Exterior Mirrors Folding Feature —If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80

▫ Electric Remote-Control Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . .81

▫ Heated Mirrors — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . .82

� Hands–Free Communication (UConnect™) —If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82

▫ Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84

▫ Phone Call Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91

▫ UConnect™ System Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93

▫ Advanced Phone Connectivity . . . . . . . . . . . . .98

▫ Things You Should Know About YourUConnect™ System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99

� Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105

▫ Manual Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105

▫ Front Seats Manual Seat Recliners . . . . . . . . . . 106

3

Page 76: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

▫ Manual Lumbar Support Adjustment —If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107

▫ Adjustable Head Restraints — Front SeatingPositions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108

▫ 6 - Way Power Seat Adjuster —Driver’s Side Only . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108

▫ Club Cab/Quad Cab Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . 110

▫ Heated Seats — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110

� To Open And Close The Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111

� Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112

▫ Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113

▫ Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114

▫ Headlamp Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114

▫ Headlights, Parking Lights, Panel Lights . . . . . 114

▫ Daytime Running Lights (Canada Only) . . . . . 115

▫ Lights-On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116

▫ Fog Lights — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116

▫ Cargo Light — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116

� Multifunction Control Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117

▫ Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117

▫ Passing Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117

▫ High Beam / Low Beam Select Switch . . . . . . 118

▫ Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118

▫ Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119

� Tilt Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120

� Electronic Speed Control — If Equipped . . . . . . 121

▫ To Activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121

76 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 77: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

▫ To Set At A Desired Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121

▫ To Deactivate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121

▫ To Resume Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122

▫ To Vary The Speed Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122

▫ To Accelerate For Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123

� Overhead Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124

▫ Courtesy/Reading Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125

� Compass/Temperature Mini-Trip Computer . . . . 125

▫ US/M Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125

▫ Reset Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126

▫ Global Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126

▫ Step Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127

▫ Average Fuel Economy (AVG ECO) . . . . . . . . 127

▫ Distance To Empty (DTE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127

▫ Trip Odometer (ODO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128

▫ Elapsed Time (ET) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128

▫ C/T Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128

▫ Compass/Temperature Display . . . . . . . . . . . 129

▫ Automatic Compass Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . 129

▫ Manual Compass Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129

▫ To Put Into a Calibration Mode . . . . . . . . . . . 129

▫ Outside Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131

� Garage Door Opener — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . 131

▫ Programming Homelink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132

▫ Canadian Programming/Gate Programming . . 135

▫ Using Homelink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 77

3

Page 78: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

▫ Erasing Homelink Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136

▫ Reprogramming a Single Homelink Button . . . 136

▫ Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137

� Power Sunroof — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138

▫ Express Open Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139

▫ Sunroof Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140

� Electrical Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140

▫ Electrical Outlet Use With Engine Off(Battery Fed Configuration) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141

� Floor Console — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142

▫ Floor Console Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142

� Center Storage Compartment — If Equipped . . . 143

� Cup Holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144

� Tailgate Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144

� Slide-In Campers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145

▫ Camper Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145

▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146

▫ Carbon Monoxide Warning Vehicles EquippedWith A Cap Or Slide-In Campers . . . . . . . . . . 146

78 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 79: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

MIRRORS

Inside Day/Night MirrorThe mirror should be adjusted to center on the viewthrough the rear window. A two-point pivot systemallows for horizontal and vertical adjustment of themirror.

Annoying headlight glare can be reduced by moving thesmall control under the mirror to the night position(toward rear of truck). The mirror should be adjustedwhile set in the day position (toward windshield).

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 79

3

Page 80: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Automatic Dimming Mirror — If EquippedThis mirror will automatically adjust for annoying head-light glare from vehicles behind you. You can turn thefeature on or off by pressing the button at the base of themirror. A light in the button will indicate when thedimming feature is activated.

CAUTION!

To avoid damage to the mirror during cleaning,never spray any cleaning solution directly onto themirror. Apply the solution onto a clean cloth andwipe the mirror clean.

Outside MirrorsTo receive maximum benefit, adjust the outside mirror(s)to center on the adjacent lane of traffic with a slightoverlap of the view obtained on the inside mirror.

Exterior Mirrors Folding Feature — If EquippedFolding exterior mirrors are hinged and may be movedeither forward or rearward to resist damage.

80 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 81: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Electric Remote-Control MirrorsThe controls for the power mirrors are located on thedriver’s door trim panel.

To adjust a mirror, turn the control wand toward the leftor right mirror positions indicated. Tilt the control wandin the direction you want the mirror to move. Whenfinished adjusting the mirror, turn the control to thecenter position to prevent accidentally moving a mirror.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 81

3

Page 82: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Vehicles and other objects seen in the right sideconvex mirror will look smaller and farther awaythan they really are. Relying too much on your rightside mirror could cause you to collide with anothervehicle or other object. Use your inside mirror whenjudging the size or distance of a vehicle seen in theright side mirror.

Heated Mirrors — If EquippedHeated mirrors are automatically activated when youdepress the rear window defroster switch located on theinstrument panel. The light will illuminate to indicatethat the heating elements are ON. Turning Off the rearwindow defroster or the ignition will deactivate theheated mirrors.

HANDS–FREE COMMUNICATION (UConnect™) —IF EQUIPPEDUConnect™ is a voice-activated, hands-free, in- vehiclecommunications system. UConnect™ allows you to diala phone number with your cellular phone using simplevoice commands (e.g., �Call” � “Mike” �”Work� or �Dial”� “248-555-1212�). Your cellular phone’s audio is trans-mitted through your vehicle’s audio system; the systemwill automatically mute your radio when using theUConnect™ system.

NOTE: The UConnect™ system use requires a cellularphone equipped with the Bluetooth �Hands-Free Profile,�version 0.96 or higher.

For UConnect Customer Support call 1-877-855-8400 orvisit the UConnect website (www.chrysler.com/uconnect).

UConnect™ allows you to transfer calls between thesystem and your cellular phone as you enter or exit yourvehicle, and enables you to mute the system’s micro-phone for private conversation.

82 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 83: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

The UConnect™ phonebook enables you to store up to 32names and four numbers per name. Each language has aseparate 32 name phonebook accessible only in thatlanguage. This system is driven through your Blue-tooth™ Hands-Free profile cellular phone. UConnect™features Bluetooth™ technology - the global standardthat enables different electronic devices to connect toeach other without wires or a docking station, so UCon-nect works no matter where you stow your cellularphone (be it your purse, pocket, or briefcase), as long asyour phone is turned on and has been paired to thevehicle’s UConnect™ system. The UConnect™ systemallows up to seven cellular phones to be linked to system.Only one linked (or paired) cellular phone can be usedwith the system at a time. The system is available inEnglish, Spanish, or French languages (as equipped).

The rearview mirror contains the microphone for thesystem and the control buttons that will enable you to

access the system. The diagram below shows the mirrorwith the appropriate buttons. Individual button behavioris discussed in the �Operation� section.

The UConnect™ system can be used with any Hands-Free Profile certified Bluetooth™ cellular phone. If yourcellular phone supports a different profile (eg., Headset

UConnect™ Switches

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 83

3

Page 84: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Profile), you may not be able to use any UConnect™features. Refer to your cellular service provider or thephone manufacturer for details.

The UConnect™ system is fully integrated with thevehicle’s audio system. The volume of the UConnect™system can either be adjusted from the radio volumecontrol knob, or from the steering wheel radio control(right switch), if so equipped.

The radio display will be used for visual prompts fromthe UConnect™ system such as �CELL� or caller ID oncertain radios.

OperationVoice commands can be used to operate the UConnect™system and to navigate through the UConnect™ menustructure. Voice commands are required after mostUConnect™ system prompts. You will be prompted for aspecific command and then guided through the availableoptions.

• Prior to giving a voice command, one must wait forthe voice on beep, which follows the �Ready� promptor another prompt.

• For certain operations, compound commands can beused. For example, instead of saying �Setup� and then�Phone Pairing,� the following compound commandcan be said: �Setup Phone Pairing.�

• For each of the feature explanation in this section, onlythe combined form of the voice command is given.You can also break the commands into parts and sayeach part of the command, when you are asked for it.For example, you can either use the combined formvoice command �Phonebook New Entry,� or you canbreak the combined form command into two voicecommands: �Phonebook� and �New Entry.� Please re-member, the UConnect™ system works best when youtalk in a normal conversational tone, as if speaking tosome one sitting eight feet away from you.

84 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 85: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Voice Command TreeRefer to “Voice Tree” at the end of this section.

Help CommandIf you need assistance at any prompt or if you want toknow what your options are at any prompt, say �Help�following the voice on beep. The UConnect™ system willplay all the options at any prompt if you ask for help.

To activate the UConnect™ system from idle, simplypress the ’Phone’ button and follow audible prompts fordirections. All UConnect™ system sessions begin with apress of the ’Phone’ button on the mirror.

Cancel CommandAt any prompt, after the voice on beep, you can say�Cancel� and you will be returned to the main menu.However, in a few instances the system will take youback to the previous menu.

Pair (Link) UConnect™ System to a Cellular PhoneTo begin using your UConnect™ system, you must pairyour compatible Bluetooth™ enabled cellular phone (re-fer to �Introduction� section to learn about the phonetype). To complete the pairing process, you will need toreference your cellular phone owner’s manual. One of thefollowing vehicle specific websites may also providedetailed instructions for pairing with the brand of phonethat you have:

NOTE:• www.chrysler.com/uconnect

• www.dodge.com/uconnect

• www.jeep.com/uconnect

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 85

3

Page 86: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

The following are general phone to UConnect™ Systempairing instructions:

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Setup Phone Pairing.�

• When prompted, after the voice on beep, say �Pair aPhone.�

• You will be asked to say a four-digit pin number whichyou will later need to enter into your cellular. You canenter any four-digit pin number. You will not need toremember this pin number after the initial pairingprocess.

• The UConnect™ system will then prompt you to beginthe cellular phone pairing process on your cellularphone. Before attempting to pair phone, please seeyour cellular phone’s user manual (Bluetooth section)for instructions on how to complete this step.

• For identification purposes, you will be prompted togive the UConnect™ system a name for your cellularphone. Each cellular phone that is paired should begiven a unique phone name.

• You will then be asked to give your cellular phone apriority level between 1 and 7, 1 being the highestpriority. You can pair up to seven cellular phones toyour UConnect™ system. However, at any given time,only one cellular phone can be in use, connected toyour UConnect™ System. The priority allows theUConnect™ system to know which cellular phone touse if multiple cellular phones are in the vehicle at thesame time. For example, if priority 3 and priority 5phones are present in the vehicle, the UConnect™system will use the priority 3 cellular phone when youmake a call. You can select to use a lower prioritycellular phone at any time (refer to �Advanced PhoneConnectivity� section).

86 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 87: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Dial by Saying a Number

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Dial.�

• System will prompt you to say the number you wantcall.

• For example, you can say �234-567-8901.� The phonenumber that you enter must be of valid length andcombination. The UConnect™ limits the user fromdialing invalid combination of numbers. For example,234-567-890 is nine digits long, which is not a validphone number - the closest valid phone number hasten digits.

• The UConnect™ system will confirm the phone num-ber and then dial. The number will appear in thedisplay of certain radios.

Call by Saying a Name

• Press the “Phone” button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Call.�

• System will prompt you to say the name of the personyou want call.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, saythe name of the person you want to call. For example,you can say �John Doe,� where John Doe is a previ-ously stored name entry in the UConnect™ phone-book. Refer to section �Add Names to Your UCon-nect™ Phonebook,� to learn how to store a name in thephonebook.

• The UConnect™ system will confirm the name andthen dial the corresponding phone number, whichmay appear in the display of certain radios.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 87

3

Page 88: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Add Names to Your UConnect™ Phonebook

NOTE: Adding names to phonebook is recommendedwhen vehicle is not in motion.

• Press the “Phone” button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Phonebook New Entry.�

• When prompted, say the name of the new entry. Use oflong names helps the voice recognition and is recom-mended. For example, say �Robert Smith� or �Robert�instead of �Bob.�

• When prompted, enter the number designation (e.g.:�Home,� �Work,� �Mobile,� or �Pager�). This will allowyou to store multiple numbers for each phonebookentry, if desired.

• When prompted, recite the phone number for thephonebook entry that you are adding.

After you are finished adding an entry into the phone-book, you will be given the opportunity to add morephone numbers to the current entry or to return to themain menu.

The UConnect™ system will allow you to enter up to 32names in the phonebook with each name having up tofour associated phone numbers and designations. Eachlanguage has a separate 32 name phonebook accessibleonly in that language.

Edit Entries in the UConnect™ Phonebook

NOTE: Editing phonebook entries is recommendedwhen vehicle is not in motion.

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Phonebook Edit.�

88 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 89: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• You will then be asked for the name of the phonebookentry that you wish to edit.

• Next, choose the number designation (home, work,mobile, or pager) that you wish to edit.

• When prompted, recite the new phone number for thephonebook entry that you are editing.

After you are finished editing an entry in the phonebook,you will be given the opportunities to edit another entryin the phonebook, call the number you just edited, orreturn to the main menu.

�Phonebook Edit� can be used to add another phonenumber to a name entry that already exists in thephonebook. For example, the entry John Doe may have amobile and a home number, but you can add John Doe’swork number later using the �Phonebook Edit� feature.

Delete Entries in the UConnect™ Phonebook

NOTE: Editing phonebook entries is recommendedwhen vehicle is not in motion.

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Phonebook Delete.�

• After you enter the Phonebook Delete menu, you willthen be asked for the name of the entry that you wishto delete. You can either say the name of a phonebookentry that you wish to delete or you can say �ListNames� to hear a list of the entries in the phonebookfrom which you choose. To select one of the entriesfrom the list, press the �Voice Recognition� buttonwhile the UConnect™ system is playing the desiredentry and say �Delete.�

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 89

3

Page 90: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• After you enter the name, the UConnect™ system willask you which designation you wish to delete: home,work, mobile or pager. Say the designation you wishto delete.

After confirmation, the phonebook entries will be de-leted. Note that only the phonebook in the currentlanguage is deleted.

Delete All Entries in the UConnect™ Phonebook

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Phonebook Erase All.�

• The UConnect™ system will ask you to verify that youwish to delete all the entries from the phonebook.

• After confirmation, the phonebook entries will bedeleted.

List All Names in the UConnect™ Phonebook

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Phonebook List Names.�

• The UConnect™ system will play the names of all thephonebook entries.

• To call one of the names in the list, press the �VoiceRecognition’ button during the playing of the desiredname and say �Call�. NOTE: the user can also exercise�Edit� or �Delete� operations at this point.

• The UConnect™ system will then prompt you as tonumber designation you wish to call.

• The selected number will be dialed.

90 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 91: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Phone Call FeaturesThe following features can be accessed through theUConnect™ system if the feature(s) are available on yourcellular service plan. For example, if your cellular serviceplan provides three-way calling, this feature can beaccessed through the UConnect™ system. Check withyour cellular service provider for the features that youhave.

Answer or Reject an Incoming Call - No CallCurrently in ProgressWhen you receive a call on your cellular phone, theUConnect™ system will interrupt the vehicle audiosystem, if on, and will ask if you would like to answer thecall. To reject the call, press and hold the ’Phone’ buttonuntil you hear a single beep indicating that the incomingcall was rejected.

Answer or Reject an Incoming Call - CallCurrently in ProgressIf a call is currently in progress and you have anotherincoming call, you will hear the same network tones forcall waiting that you normally hear when using your cellphone. Press the ’Phone’ button to place the current callon hold and answer the incoming call. NOTE: TheUConnect™ system compatible phones in market todaydo not support rejecting an incoming call when anothercall is in progress. Therefore, the user can only eitheranswer an incoming call or ignore it.

Making a Second Call while Current Call in ProgressTo make a second call while you are currently in a call,press the ’Voice Recognition’ button and say �Dial� or�Call� followed by the phone number or phonebook entryyou wish to call. The first call will be on hold while thesecond call is in progress. To go back to the first call, referto section �Toggling Between Two Calls.� To combine twocalls, refer to section �Conference Call.�

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 91

3

Page 92: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Place/Retrieve a Call from HoldTo put a call on hold, press the �Phone’ button until youhear a single beep which will indicate that the call hasbeen placed on hold. To bring the call back from hold,press and hold the �Phone’ button until you hear a singlebeep.

Toggling Between CallsIf two calls are in progress (one active and one on hold),press the ’Phone’ button until you hear a single beepindicating that the active and hold status of the two callshave switched. Only one call can be placed on hold at onetime.

Conference CallWhen two calls are in progress (one active and one onhold), press and hold the ’Phone’ button until you hear adouble beep indicating that the two calls have beenjoined into one conference call.

Three-Way CallingTo initiate three-way calling, press the ’Voice Recogni-tion’ button while a call is in progress and make a secondphone call as described in section �Making a Second Callwhile Current Call in Progress.� After the second call hasestablished, press and hold the ’Phone’ button until youhear a double beep indicating that the two calls havebeen joined into one conference call.

Call TerminationTo end a call in progress, momentarily press the �Phone’button. Only the active call(s) will be terminated and ifthere is a call on hold, it will become the new active call.

92 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 93: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Redial

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Redial.�

• The UConnect™ system will call the last number thatwas dialed on your cellular phone. Note: this may not bethe last number dialed from the UConnect™ system.

Call ContinuationCall continuation is progression of a phone call onUConnect™ system after the vehicle ignition key hasbeen switched to off. Call continuation functionalityavailable on the vehicle can be any one of three types:

• After ignition key is switched off, a call can continueon the UConnect™ system either until the call ends oruntil the vehicle battery condition dictates cessation ofthe call on the UConnect™ system and transfer of thecall to the mobile phone.

• After ignition key is switched to off, a call can continueon the UConnect™ system for certain duration, afterwhich the call is automatically transferred from theUConnect™ system to the mobile phone.

• An active call is automatically transferred to themobile phone after ignition key is switched to off.

UConnect™ System Features

Language SelectionTo change the language that the UConnect™ system isusing,

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, saythe name of the language you wish to switch to(English, Espanol, or Francais, if so equipped).

• Continue to follow the system prompts to completelanguage selection.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 93

3

Page 94: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

After selecting one of the languages, all prompts andvoice commands will be in that language.

NOTE: After every UConnect™ language change op-eration, only the language specific 32 name phonebook isusable. The phone pairing is not language specific andusable across all languages.

Emergency AssistanceIf you are in an emergency and the mobile phone isreachable:

• Pick up the phone and manually dial the emergencynumber for your area.

If the phone is not reachable and the UConnect™ systemis operational, you may reach the emergency number asfollows:

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Emergency� and the UConnect™ system will instructthe paired cellular phone to call the emergency num-ber. This feature is only supported in the USA.

NOTE: The emergency number dialed is based on theCountry where the vehicle is purchased (911 for USA/Canada and 060 for Mexico). The number called may notbe applicable with the available cellular service and area.

The UConnect™ system does slightly lower your chancesof successfully making a phone call as to that for the cellphone directly.

Your phone must be turned on and paired to the UCon-nect™ system to allow use of this vehicle feature inemergency situations when the cell phone has networkcoverage and stays paired to the UConnect™ system.

94 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 95: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Towing AssistanceIf you need towing assistance,

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Towing Assistance.�

NOTE: The Towing Assistance number dialed is basedon the Country where the vehicle is purchased (1-800-528-2069 for USA, 1-877-213-4525 for Canada, 55-14-3454for Mexico city and 1-800-712-3040 for outside Mexicocity in Mexico).

Please refer to the 24-Hour Towing Assistance coveragedetails in the DaimlerChrysler Corporation 24-HourTowing Assistance Program Guide.

PagingTo learn how to page, refer to section �Working withAutomated Systems.� Paging works properly except for

pagers of certain companies which time-out a little toosoon to work properly with the UConnect™ system.

Voice Mail CallingTo learn how to access your voice mail, refer to section�Working with Automated Systems.�

Working with Automated SystemsThis method is designed to be used in instances whereone generally has to press numbers on the cellular phonekeypad while navigating through an automated tele-phone system.

You can use your UConnect™ system to access a voice-mail system or an automated service, such as, pagingservice or automated customer service. Some servicesrequire immediate response selection, in some instances,that may be too quick for use of UConnect™ system.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 95

3

Page 96: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

When calling a number with your UConnect™ systemthat normally requires you to enter in a touch-tonesequence on your cellular phone keypad, you can pushthe ’Voice Recognition’ button and say the sequence youwish to enter followed by the word �Send.� For example,if required to enter your pin number followed with apound 3 7 4 6 #, you can press the ’Voice Recognition’button and say �3 7 4 6 # Send.� Saying a number, orsequence of numbers, followed by �Send� is also to beused to navigate through an automated customer servicecenter menu structure and to leave a number on a pager.

Barge In - Overriding PromptsThe ’Voice Recognition’ button can be used when youwish to skip part of a prompt and issue your voicerecognition command immediately. For example, if aprompt is playing �Would you like to pair a phone, cleara�,� you could press the ’Voice Recognition’ button andsay �Pair a Phone� to select that option without having tolisten to the rest of the voice prompt.

Turning Confirmation Prompts On/OffTurning confirmation prompts off will stop the systemfrom confirming your choices (e.g. the UConnect™ sys-tem will not repeat a phone number before you dial it).

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Setup Confirmations.� The UConnect™ system willplay the current confirmation prompt status and youwill be given the choice to change it.

Phone and Network Status IndicatorsThe UConnect™ system will provide notification toinform you if your cellular phone is in roaming status,has low signal strength, or has a low battery when youare trying to place a phone call.

Dialing Using the Cellular Phone KeypadYou can dial a phone number with your cellular phonekeypad and still use the UConnect™ system (while

96 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 97: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

dialing via the cell phone keypad, the user must exercisecaution and take precautionary safety measures). Bydialing a number with your paired Bluetooth™ cellularphone, the audio will be played through your vehicle’saudio system. The UConnect™ system will work thesame as if you dial the number using voice recognition.

NOTE: Certain brands of mobile phones do not send thedial ring to the UConnect™ system to play it on thevehicle audio system, so you will not hear it. Under thissituation, after successfully dialing a number, the usermay feel that the call did not go through even though thecall is in progress. Once your call is answered, you willhear the audio.

Mute/Un-mute (Mute off)When you mute the UConnect™ system, you will still beable to hear the conversation coming from the otherparty, but the other party will not be able to hear you. Inorder to mute the UConnect™ system:

• Press the ’Voice Recognition’ button.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Mute.�

In order to un-mute the UConnect™ system:

• Press the ’Voice Recognition’ button.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Mute-off.�

Information ServiceWhen using AT&T Wireless Service, dialing to phonenumber �#121,� you can access voice activated automatedsystem to receive news, weather, stocks, traffic, etc.related information.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 97

3

Page 98: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Advanced Phone Connectivity

Transfer Call to and from Cellular PhoneThe UConnect™ system allows on going calls to betransferred to your cellular phone to the UConnect™system without terminating the call. To transfer an ongo-ing call from your UConnect™ paired cellular phone tothe UConnect™ system or vice-versa, press the ’VoiceRecognition’ button and say �Transfer Call.�

Connect or Disconnect Link Between theUConnect™ System and Cellular PhoneYour cellular phone can be paired with many differentelectronic devices, but can only be actively �connected�with one electronic device at a time.

If you would like to connect or disconnect the Blue-tooth™ connection between a UConnect™ paired cellularphone and the UConnect™ system, follow the instructiondescribed in your cellular phone user’s manual.

List Paired Cellular Phone Names

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the “Ready” prompt and the following beep, say“Setup Phone pairing”.

• When prompted, say �List Phones�.

• The UConnect™ system will play the phone names ofall paired cellular phones in order from the highest tothe lowest priority. To “select” or “delete” a pairedphone being announced, press the �Voice recognition’button and say “Select” or “Delete.” Also, see the nexttwo sections for an alternate way to “select” or “de-lete” a paired phone.

Select another Cellular PhoneThis feature allows you to select and start using anotherphone with the UConnect™ system. The phone musthave been previously paired to the UConnect™ systemthat you want to use it with.

98 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 99: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Setup Select Phone.�

• The phone names (along with priority numbers) willbe played.

• When prompted say the priority number of the cellu-lar phone you wish to select. You can also press the�Voice Recognition’ button anytime while the list isbeing played and say the priority number.

• The selected phone will be used for the next phonecall. If the selected phone is not available, the UCon-nect™ system will return to using the highest priorityphone present in or near (approximately with in 30feet) the vehicle.

Delete UConnect™ Paired Cellular Phones

• Press the ’Phone’ button to begin.

• After the �Ready� prompt and the following beep, say�Setup Phone Pairing.�

• At the next prompt, say �Delete.�

• The phone names (along with priority numbers) willbe played.

• When prompted say the priority number of the cellu-lar phone (or “All” to delete all phones) you wish todelete. You can also press the �Voice Recognition’button anytime while the list is being played and saythe priority number.

Things You Should Know About Your UConnect™System

Voice Recognition (VR)

• Always wait for the beep before speaking.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 99

3

Page 100: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• Speak normally, without pausing, just as you wouldspeak to a person sitting approximately eight (8) feetaway from you.

• Make sure that no one other than you is speakingduring a voice recognition period.

• Performance is maximized under:

• low-to-medium blower setting,

• low-to-medium vehicle speed,

• low road noise,

• smooth road surface,

• fully closed windows,

• dry weather condition.

• Even though the system is designed for users speakingin North American English, French, and Spanish ac-cents, the system may not always work for some.

• When navigating through an automated system, suchas, voice mail, or when sending a page, at the end ofspeaking the digit string, make sure to say �send.�

• Storing names in phonebook when vehicle is not inmotion is recommended.

• It is not recommended to store similar soundingnames in the UConnect™ phonebook.

• UConnect™ phonebook name tag recognition rate isoptimized for the voice of the person who stored thename in the phonebook.

• You can say �O� (letter �O�) for �0� (zero). �800� must bespoken �eight-zero-zero.�

• Even though international dialing for most numbercombinations is supported, some shortcut dialingnumber combinations may not be supported.

100 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 101: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Far End Audio Performance

• Audio quality is maximized under:

• low-to-medium blower setting,

• low-to-medium vehicle speed,

• low road noise,

• smooth road surface,

• fully closed windows, and

• dry weather condition.

• Operation from driver seat.

• Performance, such as, audio clarity, echo. and loud-ness to a large degree, rely on the phone and network,and not the UConnect™ system.

• Echo at far end can sometime be reduced by loweringthe in-vehicle audio volume.

Bluetooth Communication LinkCellular phones have been found to occasionally loseconnection to the UConnect™ system. When this hap-pens, the connection can generally be re-established byswitching the phone off/on. Your cell phone is recom-mended to remain in Bluetooth �on� mode.

Power-UpAfter switching the ignition key from OFF to either ONor ACC position, or after a reset, you must wait at leastfive (5) seconds prior to using the system.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 101

3

Page 102: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

102 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 103: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 103

3

Page 104: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

104 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 105: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

North American EnglishPrimary Alternate(s)Zero OhAdd location Add newAll All of themConfirmation prompts Confirmations promptsDelete a name DeleteLanguage Select languageList names List allList paired phones List phonesPager BeeperPhone pairing PairingPhonebook Phone bookReturn to main menu Return. Main menuSelect phone selectSet up Phone settings phone set

up

SEATS

Manual Seat AdjustmentThe adjusting lever is at the front of the seat, near thefloor. Lift the lever and move the seat to the desiredposition. Release the bar to lock the seat into position.

Using body pressure, move forward and rearward on theseat to be sure the seat adjusters have latched.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 105

3

Page 106: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Adjusting a seat while the vehicle is moving isdangerous. The sudden movement of the seat couldcause you to lose control. The seat belt might not beproperly adjusted and you could be injured. Adjustany seat only while the vehicle is parked.

Front Seats Manual Seat ReclinersThe front seats are equipped with recliners. The recliningmechanism is operated by a lever located on the rightside of the passenger’s seat and the left side of thedriver’s seat. To recline, lean forward slightly beforelifting the lever, then push back to the desired positionand release the lever. Lean forward and lift the lever toreturn the seatback to its normal position. Using bodypressure, lean forward and rearward on the seat to besure the seatback is locked.

106 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 107: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that theshoulder belt is no longer resting against your chest.In a collision you could slide under the seat belt andbe seriously or even fatally injured. Use the reclineronly when the vehicle is parked.

Manual Lumbar Support Adjustment — IfEquippedThe manual lumbar support rotary control adjustment islocated on the left side of the driver’s seat. Rotate theknob to increase or decrease the amount of lumbarsupport.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 107

3

Page 108: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Adjustable Head Restraints — Front SeatingPositionsHead restraints can reduce the risk of whiplash injury inthe event of impact from the rear. Pull up or push downon the restraints so that the upper edge is as high aspractical, at least to the level of the ears.

To lower the head restraint, depress the release buttonlocated at the base of the head restraint and push downon the head restraint.

6 - Way Power Seat Adjuster — Driver’s Side OnlyThe 6-way power seat adjuster switches are on theoutboard side of the driver’s seat. Use this switch tomove the seat up or down, forward or rearward, or tilt.

108 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 109: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

The power seat controls are on the outboard side of thedriver’s seat cushion. Three switches control the seatmovement. The four-way switch in the center can bemoved forward or backwards to get the most comfortableposition. The same switch can be moved up and down to

Power Seat Control Location

Up, Down, Forward, and Rearward

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 109

3

Page 110: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

control seat height. Change the seat angle by using thetwo toggle switches, tilting it up or down.

Club Cab/Quad Cab Rear SeatMore cargo space is available by lifting up on the rearseat cushion.The Quad Cab rear seat is a 60/40 split cushion and fullback. Either cushion can be raised independently.

Heated Seats — If EquippedThe heated seat switches are located at the front of thefloor console. The engine must be running for the heatedseats to operate.Each heated seat switch has two settings (HI and LOW).Press the switch once to obtain the desired heating positionand press a second time in the same direction to turn theheated seats OFF. If you do not purposefully turn theswitch OFF, the heating element in the seat will remainactivated until the ignition is turned off. The indicators onthe switch will illuminate when the heated seats are in the(HI or LOW) position. Flashing telltale lights on the switchindicate that the Heated Seat system needs servicing.

Tilt Adjustment

110 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 111: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOODTo open the hood, two latches must be released. First pullthe hood release lever located under the left side of theinstrument panel.

Then push the safety latch lever down while lifting thegrille with your right hand. It is located at the top centerof the grille just left of center.

Lift the hood and gas filled props will hold it open.

Hood Release Lever LocationSecondary Latch Location (Push Down)

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 111

3

Page 112: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

To prevent possible damage, do not slam the hood toclose it. Use a firm downward push at the center frontedge of the hood to ensure that both latches engage.Never drive your vehicle unless the hood is fully closed,with both latches engaged.

WARNING!

If the hood is not fully latched, it could fly up whenthe vehicle is moving and block your forward vision.Be sure all hood latches are fully latched beforedriving.

LIGHTS

112 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 113: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Interior Lights

Courtesy and dome lights are turned on when the frontdoors are opened, when the dimmer control (rotatingwheel on the right side of the switch) is rotated to thesecond upward detent position, or if equipped, when theUNLOCK button is pressed on the key fob.When a dooris open and the interior lights are on, rotating the dimmer

control all the way down to the OFF detent will cause allthe interior lights to go out. This is also known as the�Party� mode because it allows the doors to stay open forextended periods of time without discharging the vehi-cle’s battery.

The brightness of the instrument panel lighting can beregulated by rotating the dimmer control up (brighter) ordown (dimmer). When the headlights are ON you cansupplement the brightness of the odometer, trip odom-eter, radio and overhead console by rotating the controlup until you hear a click. This feature is termed the“Parade” mode and is useful when headlights are re-quired during the day.

Club Cab/Quad Cab models may have an optionalswitched dome lamp that may be operated by pressingthe lens.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 113

3

Page 114: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Battery SaverTo protect the life of your vehicle’s battery, Load Shed-ding is provided for both the interior and exterior lights.

If the ignition is off and any door is left ajar for 15minutes or the dimmer control is rotated upwards for 15minutes, the interior lights will automatically turn off.

If the headlamps remain on while the ignition is cycledoff, the exterior lights will automatically turn off after 8minutes. If the headlamps are turned on and left on for 8minutes while the ignition is off, the exterior lights willautomatically turn off.

NOTE: Battery Saver mode is cancelled if the ignition isON.

Headlamp DelayTo aid in your exit, your vehicle is equipped with aheadlamp delay that will leave the headlamps on for 60seconds. This delay is initiated when the ignition isturned OFF while the headlamp switch is on, and thenthe headlamp switch is cycled off. The headlamps willremain on for 60 seconds. Headlamp delay can becancelled by either turning the headlamp switch ON thenOFF or by turning the ignition ON.

Headlights, Parking Lights, Panel LightsWhen the headlight switch is rotated to the firstposition, the parking lights, taillights, side markerlights, license plate light and instrument panel

lights are all turned on. The headlights will turn ONwhen the switch is rotated to the second position.

114 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 115: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Your vehicle is equipped with plastic headlight lensesthat are lighter and less susceptible to stone breakagethan glass headlights.

Plastic is not as scratch resistant as glass and thereforedifferent lens cleaning procedures must be followed.

To minimize the possibility of scratching the lenses andreducing light output, avoid wiping with a dry cloth. Toremove road dirt, wash with a mild soap solution fol-lowed by rinsing.

Do not use abrasive cleaning components, solvents, steelwool or other abrasive materials to clean the lenses.

Daytime Running Lights (Canada Only)The headlights on your vehicle will illuminate when theengine is started. This provides a constant �Lights ON�condition until the ignition is turned OFF. The lightsilluminate at less than 50% of normal intensity. If theparking brake is applied the Daytime Running Lightswill turn off.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 115

3

Page 116: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Lights-on ReminderIf the headlights, parking lights, courtesy lights or cargolights are left on, after the ignition is turned off, a chimewill sound when the driver’s door is opened.

Fog Lights — If EquippedThe foglights are turned ON by placing the head-light rotary control in the parking light or head-light position and pushing in the headlight rotary

control. The fog lights will operate only when the parkinglights are ON or when the vehicle headlights are ON lowbeam. An indicator light located in the instrument clusterwill illuminate when the fog lights are on. The fog lightswill turn off when the switch is pulled out, when theheadlight switch is rotated to the OFF position, or thehigh beam is selected.

CARGO Light — If Equipped

The cargo lights are turned on by pressing on theCARGO button. The interior lights will also turn onwhen the cargo lights are on. The cargo lights will alsoturn on for 30 seconds when a key fob Unlock is pressed,as part of the illuminated entry feature.

116 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 117: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

MULTIFUNCTION CONTROL LEVERThe multifunction control lever is located on the left sideof the steering column.

Turn Signals

Move the lever up or down to signal a right-hand orleft-hand turn.

The arrow on either side of the instrument cluster flashesto indicate the direction of the turn, and proper operationof the front and rear turn signal lights. If an indicator failsto light when the lever is moved, it would suggest thatthe switch or indicator lamp is defective.

If a defective bulb or wiring circuit is detected for theturn signal system, the arrow indicators will flash at afaster rate.

You can signal a lane change by moving the leverpartially up or down.

NOTE: If a turn signal has been left on for at least a mileduration, a continuous chime will sound.

Passing LightYou can signal another vehicle with your headlights bypartially pulling the multifunction lever toward the steer-ing wheel. This will cause the high beam headlights toturn on until the lever is released.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 117

3

Page 118: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

High Beam / Low Beam Select SwitchPull the multifunction control lever fully toward thesteering wheel to switch the headlights from HIGH orLOW beam.

Windshield Wipers

The wipers and washers are operated by a switch in themultifunction control lever. Turn the end of the handle toselect the desired wiper speed.

Intermittent Wiper SystemThe intermittent feature of this system was designed foruse when weather conditions make a single wiping cycle,

118 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 119: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

with a variable pause between cycles, desirable. Formaximum delay between cycles, rotate the control knobinto the upper end of the delay range.

The delay interval decreases as you rotate the knob untilit enters the LO continual speed position. The delay canbe regulated from a maximum of about 18 secondsbetween cycles, to a cycle every 2 seconds. The delayintervals will double in duration when the vehicle speedis 10 mph (16 km) or less.

WARNING!

Sudden loss of visibility through the windshieldcould lead to an accident. You might not see othervehicles or other obstacles. To avoid sudden icing ofthe windshield during freezing weather, warm thewindshield with defroster before and during wind-shield washer use.

NOTE: If the front wiper is operating when the ignitionis turned off, the wiper will automatically return to the�Park� position. When the vehicle is restarted, the wiperswill resume operation.

Windshield WashersTo use the washer, push in on the washer knob on the endof the multifunction control lever and hold while spray isdesired. If the washer knob is depressed while in thedelay range, the wiper will operate for several secondsafter the washer knob is released. It will then resume theintermittent interval previously selected. If the washerknob is pushed, for a period greater than 1 second, whilein the OFF position, the wiper will wipe approximatelythree wipes, after the wash knob is released.

To prevent freeze-up of your windshield washer system incold weather, select a solution or mixture that meets orexceeds the temperature range of your climate. This ratinginformation can be found on most washer fluid containers.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 119

3

Page 120: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

TILT STEERING COLUMNTo tilt the column, push down on the lever below the turnsignal control and move the wheel up or down, asdesired.

WARNING!

Tilting the steering column while the vehicle ismoving is dangerous. Without a stable steering col-umn, you could lose control of the vehicle and havean accident. Adjust the column only while the ve-hicle is stopped. Be sure it is locked before driving.

120 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 121: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL — IF EQUIPPEDWhen engaged, this device takes over accelerator opera-tion at speeds greater than (refer to the table below forthe speed for your specific engine). The controls aremounted on the steering wheel.

To ActivatePush the ON/OFF button to the ON position. In theinstrument cluster, the word “CRUISE” illuminates whenthe system is on.

To Set At A Desired SpeedWhen the vehicle has reached the desired speed, pressand release the SET button. Release the accelerator andthe vehicle will operate at the selected speed.

To DeactivateA soft tap on the brake pedal, normal braking, or pressingthe CANCEL button will deactivate speed control with-out erasing the memory. Pushing the ON/OFF button tothe OFF position or turning off the ignition erases thememory.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 121

3

Page 122: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Leaving the Speed Control ON when not in use isdangerous. You could accidentally set the system tocause it to go faster than you want. You could losecontrol and have an accident. Always leave thesystem OFF when you aren’t using it.

To Resume SpeedTo resume a previously set speed, push and release theRESUME button. Resume can be used at any speed above(refer to the table below for the speed for your specificengine).

To Vary The Speed SettingWhen the speed control is on, speed can be increased bypressing and holding the ACCEL button. When thebutton is released, a new set speed will be established.

Tapping the ACCEL button once will result in a speedincrease (refer to the table below for the speed for yourspecific engine). Each time the button is tapped, speedincreases so that tapping the button three times willincrease speed by three increments.

Tapping the DECEL button once will result in a speeddecrease (refer to the table below for the speed for yourspecific engine). Each time the button is tapped, speedwill decrease. For example, tapping the button 3 timeswill decrease the speed by 3 times the speed listed in thetable below (refer to the table below for the speed foryour specific engine).

To decrease speed while the speed control is on, pressand hold the DECEL button. Release the button when thedesired speed is reached, and the new speed will be set.

122 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 123: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Functions 3.7L 4.7L 4.7L HOEngage Speed 30 mph (48 km/h) 30 mph (48 km/h) 30 mph (48 km/h)Minimun RESUME Speed 25 mph (40 km/h) 25 mph (40 km/h) 25 mph (40 km/h)ACCEL Increase 2 mph (3km/h) 2 mph (3km/h) 2 mph (3 km/h)DECEL Decrease 1 mph (2 km/h) 1 mph (2 km/h) 1 mph (2 km/h)Dropout Speed 25 mph (40 km/h) 25 mph (40 km/h) 25 mph (40 km/h)

To Accelerate For PassingDepress the accelerator as you would normally. When thepedal is released, the vehicle will return to the set speed.

NOTE: When driving uphill, at elevations above 2,000feet (610 meters), or when the vehicle is heavily loaded(especially when towing) the vehicle may slow below theSET speed. If the vehicle speed drops below (refer to thetable below for the speed for your specific engine), thespeed control will automatically disengage. If this hap-pens, you can push down on the accelerator pedal tomaintain the desired speed.

Vehicles equipped with a Automatic transmission mayexhibit several downshifts under the above conditions.To reduce the frequency of the downshifts and to im-prove vehicle performance, it is advisable to lock outoverdrive by pressing the “TOW/HAUL” button locatedat the end of the gear shifter.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 123

3

Page 124: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Speed Control can be dangerous where the systemcan’t maintain a constant speed. Your vehicle couldgo too fast for the conditions, and you could losecontrol. An accident could be the result. Don’t useSpeed Control in heavy traffic or on roads that arewinding, icy, snow-covered, or slippery.

OVERHEAD CONSOLEThe overhead console has the following features:

• Courtesy Lights

• Garage Door Opener — If Equipped

• Compass/Temperature Mini-Trip Computer — IfEquipped

124 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 125: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Courtesy/Reading LightsNear the front of the console are two courtesy/readinglights.

Both lights illuminate as courtesy lights when a door isopened, when the dimmer control is rotated to thecourtesy light position (fully upward position), or whenthe UNLOCK button is pressed on the Remote KeylessEntry transmitter, if so equipped. These lights are alsooperated individually as reading lights by pressing therecessed area of the corresponding lens.

NOTE: The courtesy/reading lights will remain on untilthe switch is pressed a second time, so be sure they havebeen turned off before leaving the vehicle. If the interiorlights are left on after the vehicle is turned OFF, they willextinguish after 8 minutes.

COMPASS/TEMPERATURE MINI-TRIP COMPUTERThis feature allows you to choose between a compass/temperature display and one of four trip conditions beingmonitored.

US/M ButtonUse this button to change the display from U.S. to metricmeasurement units.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 125

3

Page 126: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

RESET Button

Use this button to reset the following displays to zero:

• Average Fuel Economy

• Trip Odometer

• Elapsed time.

Global ResetIf the RESET button and STEP button are pressed at thesame time and held for 3 seconds the Global Reset featurewill reset the distance to empty (using a default fueleconomy value), fuel economy, trip odometer, andelapsed time displays.

126 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 127: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Step Button

Use this button to choose or cycle through the four tripconditions.

Average Fuel Economy (AVG ECO)Shows the average fuel economy since the last reset. Thisdisplay mode becomes less sensitive to instantaneouschanges in fuel consumption as the number of totalvehicle miles since the last reset increases. It is suggestedthat this mode be reset periodically for general operationor when driving conditions change significantly (forexample, at the end of a trip or when a trailer isconnected or disconnected).

Distance To Empty (DTE)Shows the estimated distance that can be travelled withthe fuel remaining in the tank. The estimated distance isdetermined by a weighted average of the instantaneousand average fuel economy, according to the current fueltank level.

When Distance To Empty = 0, the fuel gauge pointer willinitially be on the red “E” marker. At this point (fuelgauge pointer on the the red “E” marker) there is reserve

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 127

3

Page 128: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

fuel capacity, which corresponds to approximately 8% oftank volume. This reserve capacity was put in place toprevent the likelihood of customers running out of fuelwhen operating at maximum load conditions in areaswhere there aren’t many gas stations.

NOTE: The Distance To Empty will remain equal tozero, until the vehicle runs out of fuel or is refueled.

Trip Odometer (ODO)This display shows the distance traveled since the lastreset.

Elapsed Time (ET)This display shows the accumulated ignition ON timesince the last reset.

C/T Button

Use this button to select a readout of the outside tem-perature and one of eight compass headings that indicatethe direction in which the vehicle is facing.

128 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 129: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Compass/Temperature Display

WARNING!

Even if the display still reads a few degrees above32°F ( 0°C), the road surface may be icy, particularlyin woods or on bridges. Drive carefully under suchconditions to prevent an accident and possible per-sonal injury or property damage.

Automatic Compass CalibrationThis compass is self-calibrating which eliminates theneed to manually set the compass. When the vehicle isnew, the compass may appear erratic and the CALsymbol will be displayed.

After completing one 360° turn, with the vehicle travelingless than 5 mph (8 km/h), in an area free from large metalor metallic objects, the CAL symbol will turn off and thecompass will function normally.

Manual Compass Calibration

NOTE: To ensure proper compass calibration, makesure the compass variance is properly set before manu-ally calibrating the compass.

If the compass appears erratic and the CAL symbol doesnot appear, you must manually put the compass into the“Calibration” mode.

To Put Into a Calibration ModeTurn on the ignition and set the display to “Compass/Temperature.” Press and hold the RESET button tochange the display between VAR (compass variance) andCAL (compass calibration) modes. When the CAL sym-bol is displayed complete one 360 degree turn in an area

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 129

3

Page 130: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

free from large metal objects or power lines. The CALsymbol will turn off and the compass will functionnormally.

Compass Variance is the difference between magneticnorth and geographic north. In some areas of the country,the difference between magnetic and geographic north isgreat enough to cause the compass to give false readings.If this occurs, the compass variance must be set accordingto the Compass Variance Map.

To set the variance: Turn the ignition ON and set thedisplay to “Compass/Temperature.” Press and hold theRESET button approximately five seconds. The last vari-ance zone number will be displayed. Press the STEPbutton to select the new variance zone and press theRESET button to resume normal operation.

130 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 131: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Outside TemperatureBecause the ambient temperature sensor is located un-derhood, engine temperature can influence the displayedtemperature, therefore, temperature readings are slowlyupdated when the vehicle speed is below 20 mph (30km/h) or during stop and go driving.

GARAGE DOOR OPENER — IF EQUIPPEDThe HomeLink� Universal Transceiver replaces up tothree remote controls (hand held transmitters) that oper-ate devices such as garage door openers, motorizedgates, or home lighting. It triggers these devices at thepush of a button. The Universal Transceiver operates offyour vehicle’s battery and charging system; no batteriesare needed.

For additional information on HomeLink�, call 1–800–355–3515, or on the internet at www.homelink.com.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 131

3

Page 132: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

A moving garage door can cause injury to people andpets in the path of the door. People or pets could beseriously or fatally injured. Only use this transceiverwith a garage door opener that has a “stop andreverse” feature as required by federal safety stan-dards. This includes most garage door opener mod-els manufactured after 1982. Do not use a garagedoor opener without these safety features it couldcause injury or death. Call toll-free 1–800–355–3515or, on the Internet at www.homelink.com for safetyinformation or assistance.

Programming HomeLink

NOTE: When programming a garage door opener, it isadvised to park outside the garage. It is also recom-mended that a new battery be placed in the hand-heldtransmitter of the device being programmed toHomeLink for quicker training and accurate transmis-sion of the radio-frequency signal.

1. Press and hold the two outer HomeLink buttons, andrelease only when the indicator light begins to flash (after20 seconds). Do not hold the buttons for longer than 30seconds and do not repeat step one to program a secondand/or third hand-held transmitter to the remaining twoHomeLink buttons.

132 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 133: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Vehicle exhaust contains carbon monoxide, a danger-ous gas. Do not run the vehicle’s exhaust whiletraining the transceiver. Exhaust gas can cause seri-ous injury or death.

WARNING!

Your motorized door or gate will open and closewhile you are training the Universal Transceiver. Donot train the transceiver if people or pets are in thepath of the door or gate. A moving door or gate cancause serious injury or death to people and pets ordamage to objects.

2. Position the end of your hand-held transmitter 1-3inches (3-8 cm) away from the HomeLink buttons whilekeeping the indicator light in view.

3. Simultaneously press and hold both the HomeLinkbutton that you want to train and the hand-held trans-mitter buttons. Do not release the buttons until step 4has been completed.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 133

3

Page 134: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: Some gate operators and garage door openersmay require you to replace this Programming Step 3 withprocedures noted in the �Gate Operator/Canadian Pro-gramming� section.

4. The HomeLink indicator light will flash slowly andthen rapidly after HomeLink successfully receives thefrequency signal from the hand-held transmitter. Releaseboth buttons after the indicator light changes from theslow to the rapid flash.

5. Press and hold the just trained HomeLink button andobserve the indicator light. If the indicator light stays onconstantly, programming is complete and your deviceshould activate when the HomeLink button is pressedand released.

NOTE: To program the remaining two HomeLink but-tons, begin with �Programming� step two. Do not repeatstep one.

If the indicator light blinks rapidly for two seconds andthen turns to a constant light, continue with �Program-ming� steps 6-8 to complete the programming of a rollingcode equipped device (most commonly a garage dooropener).

6. At the garage door opener receiver (motor-head unit)in the garage, locate the �learn� or �smart� button. Thiscan usually be found where the hanging antenna wire isattached to the motor-head unit.

7. Firmly press and release the �learn� or �smart� button.(The name and color of the button may vary by manu-facturer.)

NOTE: There are 30 seconds in which to initiate stepeight.

134 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 135: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

8. Return to the vehicle and firmly press, hold for twoseconds and release the programmed HomeLink button.Repeat the �press/hold/release� sequence a second time,and, depending on the brand of the garage door opener(or other rolling code equipped device), repeat thissequence a third time to complete the programming.

HomeLink should now activate your rolling codeequipped device.

NOTE: To program the remaining two HomeLink but-tons, begin with �Programming� step two. Do not repeatstep one. For questions or comments, please contactHomeLink at www.homelink.com or 1-800-355-3515.

Canadian Programming/Gate ProgrammingCanadian radio-frequency laws require transmitter sig-nals to �time-out� (or quit) after several seconds oftransmission which may not be long enough forHomeLink to pick up the signal during programming.

Similar to this Canadian law, some U.S. gate operators aredesigned to �time-out� in the same manner.

If you live in Canada or you are having difficultiesprogramming a gate operator by using the �Program-ming� procedures (regardless of where you live), replace�Programming HomeLink� step 3 with the following:

NOTE: If programming a garage door opener or gateoperator, it is advised to unplug the device during the�cycling� process to prevent possible overheating.3. Continue to press and hold the HomeLink buttonwhile you press and release every two seconds (�cycle�)your hand-held transmitter until the frequency signal hassuccessfully been accepted by HomeLink. (The indicatorlight will flash slowly and then rapidly.) Proceed with�Programming� step four to complete.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 135

3

Page 136: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Using HomeLinkTo operate, simply press and release the programmedHomeLink button. Activation will now occur for thetrained device (i.e. garage door opener, gate operator,security system, entry door lock, home/office lighting,etc.). For convenience, the hand-held transmitter of thedevice may also be used at any time. In the event thatthere are still programming difficulties or questions,contact HomeLink at: www.homelink.com or 1-800-355-3515.

Erasing HomeLink ButtonsTo erase programming from the three buttons (individualbuttons cannot be erased but can be �reprogrammed� -note below), follow the step noted:

• Press and hold the two outer HomeLink buttons untilthe indicator light begins to flash-after 20 seconds.Release both buttons. Do not hold for longer that 30

seconds. HomeLink is now in the train (or learning)mode and can be programmed at any time beginningwith �Programming� - step 2.

Reprogramming a Single HomeLink ButtonTo program a device to HomeLink using a HomeLinkbutton previously trained, follow these steps:

1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink button. DoNOT release the button.

2. The indicator light will begin to flash after 20 seconds.Without releasing the HomeLink button, proceed with�Programming� step 2

For questions or comments, contact HomeLink at:www.homelink.com or 1-800-355-3515.

136 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 137: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Security

Garage Door Opener Operation with SecurityAlarm (if equipped)If your vehicle is equipped with the Security Alarmfeature, the operation of the HomeLink feature will bepurposely inhibited if the Security Alarm is �Armed�.This prevents HomeLink operation due to un-authorizedvehicle entry. HomeLink operation will be re-storedwhen the Security Alarm has been �Disarmed�.

If you sell your vehicle, be sure to erase the frequencies.

To erase all of the previously trained frequencies, holddown both outside buttons until the green light begins toflash.

This device complies with part 15 of FCC rules and withRSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to thefollowing conditions:

• This device may not cause harmful interference.

• This device must accept any interference that may bereceived including interference that may cause undes-ired operation.

NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly ap-proved by the party responsible for compliance couldvoid the user’s authority to operate the equipment.

HomeLink� is a trademark owned by Johnson Controls,Inc.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 137

3

Page 138: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

POWER SUNROOF — IF EQUIPPEDThe sunroof control is located on the headliner betweenthe sun visors.

Press and hold the switch rearward to fully open thesunroof. The sunroof can be stopped at any positionbetween closed and full open. Momentarily pressing theswitch rearward will activate the Express Open Feature,causing the sunroof to open automatically.

Sunroof Switch (No Console)

138 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 139: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Press and hold the “V” button in the center of the sunroofswitch to open the vent. The sunroof can be stopped atany position between closed and full vent. To close thesunroof from the vent position, press and hold the switchforward. Releasing the switch will stop the movement of

the sunroof and the sunroof will remain in the partialvent position until the switch is pushed forward again.

Express Open FeatureDuring the Express Open operation, any movement ofthe switch will stop the sunroof and it will remain in apartial open position. Again, momentarily pressing theswitch rearward will activate the Express Open Feature.

To close the sunroof, hold the switch in the forwardposition. Again, any release of the switch will stop themovement and the sunroof will remain in a partial opencondition until the switch is pushed forward again. Thesunroof is not completely closed until the rear of thesunroof glass moves upward at the end of it’s travel.

The sunshade can be opened manually. It will also openas the sunroof opens. The sunshade cannot be closed ifthe sunroof is open.

Sunroof Switch Console

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 139

3

Page 140: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

• In an accident, there is a greater risk of beingthrown from a vehicle with an open sunroof. Youcould also be seriously injured or killed. Alwaysfasten your seat belt properly and make sure allpassengers are properly secured too.

• Do not allow small children to operate the sun-roof. Never allow fingers or other body parts, orany object to project through the sunroof opening.Injury may result.

Sunroof MaintenanceUse only a non-abrasive cleaner and a soft cloth to cleanthe glass panel.

ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETSThis vehicle has two 12V auxiliary power outlets that canprovide up to 20 Amps of current for accessories de-signed for use with standard power outlet adapters. Theoutlets are located in the instrument panel, below thetemperature control setting knob, and the other inside thefull - size center console. As a safety precaution, the outletin the instrument panel only operates with the ignitionswitch ON. When the optional Cigar Lighter heatingelement is used, it heats when pushed in and pops outautomatically when ready for use. To preserve the heat-ing element, do not hold the lighter in the heatingposition.

140 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 141: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

The console outlet can be reconfigured by the customer tooperate only when the ignition is On (switch battery fed)or with the ignition switch On/Off (battery fed) to allowfor cellular phone charging and/or operation while theignition is Off.

NOTE: All accessories connected to these outlets shouldbe removed or turned OFF when the vehicle is not in useto protect the battery against discharge (unless the cus-tomer has reconfigured the fuse block to switched batteryfeed).

Electrical Outlet Use With Engine OFF (BatteryFed Configuration)

CAUTION!

• Many accessories that can be plugged in draw powerfrom the vehicle’s battery, even when not in use (i.e.cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if plugged in longenough, the vehicle’s battery will discharge suffi-ciently to degrade battery life and/or prevent enginestarting.

• Accessories that draw higher power (i.e. coolers,vacuum cleaners, lights, etc.), will discharge thebattery even more quickly. Use these only intermit-tently and with greater caution.

• After the use of high power draw accessories, or longperiods of the vehicle not being started (with acces-sories still plugged in), the vehicle must be driven asufficient length of time to allow the generator torecharge the vehicle’s battery.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 141

3

Page 142: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

FLOOR CONSOLE — IF EQUIPPED

Floor Console Features

Floor Console Features

The Floor Console between the driver’s and front pas-senger’s seat has the following features:

• Miscellaneous storage compartments

• Flexible cup holder inserts

• Portable phone storage bin

• Portable phone cord routing between lid and base onforward edge

• 12 Volt power outlet inside storage compartment

• Side open armrest lid

• Tissue holder & pen holder

• Coin slots

The coin slots are located under the instrument panelcenter stack.

Storage CompartmentsSome miscellaneous storage compartments and cupholders have rubber mats at the bottom, the mats areboth removable and dishwasher safe for cleaning pur-poses. Various storage compartments provide versatileand useful storage. A coin holder is also provided insidethe console storage compartment.

Cup HoldersThe cup holders fit a wide variety of cup and bottle sizes.To use the adjustable cup holders (only in automatictransmission vehicles), place your beverage in the cupholder, then adjust the movable arms to tightly hold thebeverage.

142 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 143: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Power Outlet and Portable Phone StorageThe console is equipped with a power outlet, portablephone storage bin, and phone cord routing. The phonestorage bin can be used when easy access to the phone isneeded. Also, the power outlet inside console compart-ment can be used to charge the phone while it is beingstored in the bin. To use plug in the portable powerrecharge cord and place the cord along the slot providedin the left side of the console. Close the console armrestlid and plug the power cord into the phone while restingthe phone in the bin. The power outlet may be used forany portable item with a standard 12 volt power plug.

Side Open Armrest LidPressing the button on the left side of the console opensthe console armrest lid. The armrest lid will remain openuntil armrest lid is closed manually by pressing the lidback into place. A penholder is provided on the inside of

the armrest lid. A tissue holder is also provided on theinside of the armrest lid, which holds a pocket size softpack of tissue.

CENTER STORAGE COMPARTMENT — IFEQUIPPEDThe center portion of the seat folds down to provide anarmrest with unique storage compartments under the lid.Push the button on the armrest to raise the lid. Compart-ments include a holder which will accommodate fivecompact disks with finger notches for easier access, apencil tray, a coin holder, and a large open area formiscellaneous items.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 143

3

Page 144: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

CUP HOLDERSIf your vehicle has bucket seats with a center console,there are three cup holders located on the console. Referto the section on floor console.

A two-cavity cup holder is available on all Quad Cabwith rear seats mounted on the floor.

TAILGATE REMOVALTo simplify mounting a camper unit with an overhang,the tailgate can be removed quickly. Follow these steps:

1. Open the tailgate to a 45° angle.

Front Cup Holders – Quad Cab with Automatic

Rear Cup Holders – Quad Cab with Automatic

144 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 145: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

2. Unclip and remove the cables from the box whilemaintaining a 45° angle.

3. Lift the tailgate off of the pivot on the passenger sideby pulling upward and rearward at the same time.

4. Slide the tailgate to the passenger side while makingsure clearance from the box and taillight is maintained.

To reinstall the tailgate, do the following:

1. Slide the tailgate onto the driver’s side pivot.

2. Hold the tailgate at a 45° angle and insert it into thepassenger side pivot.

3. Clip the cables to the box.

SLIDE-IN CAMPERS

Camper ApplicationsCertain truck models are not recommended for slide-incampers. To determine if your vehicle is excluded, pleaserefer to the Consumer Information Truck-Camper Load-ing document located in your Owner’s Manual packet oravailable from your dealer. For safety reasons, follow allinstructions on this important document.

UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 145

3

Page 146: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

General InformationThe Manufacturer’s Warranty does not apply to bodymodifications and special equipment, such as a camperunit, heaters, stoves, refrigerators, etc., supplied bymanufacturers other than the manufacturer. For warrantycoverage and service on these items, contact the appli-cable manufacturer.

To mount a camper unit with an overhang, the tailgatecan be removed. Unlatch tailgate and remove supportcables from the retainer pins. Raise right side of tailgateuntil the lower right side pivot clears the hanger bracket.Then slide the tailgate to the right to remove.

Carbon Monoxide Warning Vehicles EquippedWith A Cap or Slide-In CampersTo avoid inhaling carbon monoxide, which is deadly, theexhaust system on vehicles equipped with “Cap orSlide-In Campers” should extend beyond the overhang-ing camper compartment and be free of leaks.

146 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE

Page 147: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

CONTENTS

� Instruments And Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150

� Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151

� Instrument Cluster Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152

� Radio Reception Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159

▫ AM Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159

▫ FM Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159

� Electronic Digital Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159

▫ Clock Setting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160

� Sales Code REF — AM/FM/CD (Single Disc)Radio With Optional Hands Free PhoneCapability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160

▫ Operating Instructions - Radio Mode . . . . . . . 161

▫ Operation Instructions - CD Mode . . . . . . . . . 164

▫ Operating Instructions - Hands Free Phone —If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166

� Sales Code RAQ – AM/FM/CD (6-Disc) RadioWith Optional Satellite Radio, Hands Free Phone,And Video Capabilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166

▫ Operating Instructions - Radio Mode . . . . . . . 166

4

Page 148: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

▫ Operation Instructions -(CD Mode For CD Audio Play) . . . . . . . . . . . 170

▫ Load/Eject Button(CD Mode For CD Audio Play) . . . . . . . . . . . 171

▫ Notes On Playing MP3 Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173

▫ Operation Instructions -(CD Mode For MP3 Audio Play) . . . . . . . . . . 176

▫ Load/Eject Button (CD Mode For MP3 Play) . . 176

� Satellite Radio — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178

▫ System Activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178

▫ Electronic Serial Number/Sirius IdentificationNumber (ESN/SID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178

▫ Selecting Satellite Mode In REF Radios . . . . . . 179

▫ Selecting Satellite Mode In RAQ Radios . . . . . 179

▫ Selecting a Channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180

▫ Storing And Selecting Pre-Set Channels . . . . . . 180

▫ Using The PTY (Program Type) Button —If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180

▫ PTY Button �Scan� . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181

▫ PTY Button �Seek� . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181

▫ Satellite Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181

▫ Reception Quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181

� Remote Sound System Controls — If Equipped . . 182

▫ Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182

▫ CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183

� Compact Disc Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183

� Radio Operation And Cellular Phones . . . . . . . . 184

148 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 149: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

� Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184

▫ Air Conditioning And Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184

▫ Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188

▫ Operation Tips Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190

� Rear Window Defroster – If Equipped . . . . . . . . 191

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 149

4

Page 150: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

INSTRUMENTS AND CONTROLS

150 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 151: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

INSTRUMENT CLUSTER

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 151

4

Page 152: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTION

1. Fuel GaugeThe fuel gauge shows level of fuel in tank whenignition switch is in the ON position.

2. Temperature GaugeThe temperature gauge indicates engine coolanttemperature. Any reading within the normalrange indicates that the cooling system is operat-

ing satisfactorily. The gauge needle will likely indicate ahigher temperature when driving in hot weather, upmountain grades, in heavy traffic, or when towing atrailer. If the needle rises to the “H” mark, stop thevehicle, shift into N (Neutral), and increase engine speedfor 2-3 minutes. If the temperature reading does notreturn to normal, seek authorized service immediately.

CAUTION!

Do not leave your vehicle unattended with theengine running as you would not be able to react tothe temperature indicator if the engine overheats.

The gauge pointer will remain near its last reading whenthe engine is turned off. It will return to a true readingwhen the engine is restarted.

3. Turn Signal IndicatorsWhen a turn signal is activated, a right-pointing orleft-pointing arrow lights up and flashes to indicate thedirection of the turn. These indicators also indicateproper operation of the front and rear turn signal lights.If either indicator flashes at a faster rate than normal,check for a defective bulb. If either indicator fails to lightup when the lever is moved, check for a defective fuse orturn signal LED. A single chime is activated when the

152 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 153: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

left/right turn signal is left on with the engine RPMvehicle speed greater than 15 mph (24 km/h) for morethan one mile.

4. Low Fuel Warning LightThis indicator lights when the fuel gauge reads 1/8of a tank or less. There is a pointer on the side ofthis symbol that indicates the side that your fuel

filler door is located.

5. High Beam IndicatorIndicates that headlights are on high beam.

6. Seat Belt Reminder LightThis light comes on for several seconds after theignition is turned ON as a reminder to “buckleup.” This light will remain on as long as the seat

belt remains unbuckled. If this light flashes, it indicates afault in the airbag system. Have the system checked byan authorized dealer.

7. Fog Light Indicator — If EquippedThis light shows when the fog lights are ON.

8. Coolant Temperature LightThis light warns of an overheated engine condi-tion. For a bulb check, this light will come onmomentarily when the ignition is turned On. If the

light turns on while driving, stop the vehicle, shift into N(Neutral) and increase the engine speed for 2 to 3minutes. If the temperature reading does not return tonormal, seek authorized service immediately.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 153

4

Page 154: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

CAUTION!

Driving with a hot engine cooling system coulddamage your vehicle. If the temperature light is on,safely pull over and stop the vehicle. Idle the vehiclein neutral with the air conditioner turned off untilthe light turns off. If the if the light remains on, turnthe engine off immediately, and call for service.

WARNING!

A hot engine cooling system is dangerous. You orothers could be badly burned by steam or boilingcoolant. You may want to call a service center if yourvehicle overheats. If you decide to look under thehood yourself, see Section 7 of this manual. Followthe warnings under the Cooling System PressureCap paragraph.

9. SpeedometerShows the vehicles speed.

10. Voltage LightThis light monitors the electrical system voltage.The light should turn on momentarily as the

engine is started. If the light stays on or turns on whiledriving, it indicates a problem with the charging system.Immediate service should be obtained.

11. Security LightThis light will flash rapidly for approximately 15 secondswhen the vehicle theft alarm is arming. The light willflash at a slower speed continuously after the alarm is set.The security light will also come on for about threeseconds when the ignition is first turned on.

154 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 155: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

12. ABS Warning LightThis light monitors the Anti-Lock Brake Systemwhich is described elsewhere in this manual.This light will come on when the ignition key isturned to the ON position and may stay on for

approximately 3 seconds. If this light remains on orcomes on during driving, it indicates that the Anti-Lockportion of the brake system is not functioning and thatservice is required. See your authorized dealer immedi-ately.

13. Engine Oil Pressure Indicator LightThis light indicates that the engine oil pressure hasbecome too low. For a bulb check, this light will

come on momentarily when the ignition is turned On. Ifthe light turns on while driving, stop the vehicle and shutoff the engine as soon as possible. Immediate serviceshould be obtained.

14. TachometerThis gauge measures engine revolutions-per-minute(rpm x 1000).

15. Gear SelectorThe electronic gear selector display is self-containedwithin the instrument cluster. It displays the position ofthe automatic transmission shift lever, and the relation ofeach position to all other positions. For a good signal thedisplay will place a box around the selected transmissionrange (PRND21). If the PRNDL displays only the char-acters PRND21 (no boxes), have the system checked byan authorized dealer.

16. OdometerThe odometer shows the total distance the vehicle hasbeen driven.

U.S. federal regulations require that upon transfer ofvehicle ownership, the seller certify to the purchaser the

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 155

4

Page 156: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

correct mileage that the vehicle has been driven. There-fore, if the odometer reading is changed during repair orreplacement, be sure to keep a record of the readingbefore and after the service so that the correct mileage canbe determined.

17. Trip OdometerThe trip odometer shows individual trip mileage. Totoggle between the odometer and the trip odometer,press the Odometer/Trip Odometer Button. To reset theTrip Odometer, press and hold the button while in tripmode, until the Trip Odometer resets.

If the vehicle diagnostic system determines that the fuelfiller cap is loose, improperly installed, or damaged,GASCAP will be displayed in the instrument cluster.Tighten the fuel filler cap properly and press the odom-eter reset button to turn the GASCAP message off. If theproblem continues, the message will appear the next timethe vehicle is started.

18. Transmission Temperature IndicatorThis light indicates that there is excessive transmissionfluid temperature that might occur with severe usagesuch as trailer towing. If this light comes on, stop thevehicle and run the engine at idle or faster, with thetransmission in NEUTRAL until the light goes off.

19. Does not ApplyThis indicator is not available.

20. Door AjarThe Door Ajar light will illuminate when the ignition isON and any one of the passenger doors are opened.

NOTE: A chime will sound if the vehicle is rolling anda door has been opened.

21. BRAKE System Warning LightThis light will light when the ignition key is turned to theON position and will remain on for a few seconds. If thelight stays on, it may be an indication that the parking

156 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 157: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

brake has not been released, or there is a low brake fluidlevel. If the light remains on when the parking brake hasbeen disengaged, and the fluid level is at the full mark onthe master cylinder reservoir, it indicates a possible brakehydraulic system malfunction. In this case, the light willremain on until the condition has been corrected. If theparking brake is applied, the light will flash when thegear position is out of park for automatic transmissions.

If brake failure is indicated, immediate repair is neces-sary. Operating the vehicle in this condition is danger-ous!

22. Low Washer Fluid IndicatorThis light comes on when the washer fluid level fallsbelow approximately 1/4 full. The light will remain onuntil fluid is added and ignition switch is cycled.

23. Headlights On IndicatorIndicate when your headlights are on.

24. Malfunction Indicator LightThis light is part of an onboard diagnostic systemwhich monitors the emissions and engine controlsystem. If the vehicle is ready for emissions

testing the light will come on when the ignition is firstturned on and remain on, as a bulb check, until theengine is started. If the vehicle is not ready for emissionstesting the light will come on when the ignition is firstturned on and remain on for 15 seconds, then blink for 5seconds, and remain on until the vehicle is started. If thebulb does not come on during starting, have the condi-tion investigated promptly.

If this light comes on and remains on while driving, itsuggests a potential engine control problem and the needfor system service.

Although your vehicle will usually be drivable and notneed towing, see your dealer for service as soon aspossible.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 157

4

Page 158: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

CAUTION!

Prolonged driving with the MIL on could causedamage to the engine control system. It also couldaffect fuel economy and driveability.

If the MIL is flashing, severe catalytic converterdamage and power loss will soon occur. Immediateservice is required.

25. Airbag IndicatorThe indicator lights and remains lit for 6 to 8seconds when the ignition is first turned ON. Ifthe light does not come on when the ignition isfirst turned on, or the light stays on or comes

on while driving, have the airbag system checked by anauthorized dealer.

26. 4LO IndicatorIndicates when transfer case is in 4LO position.

27. SVC (Service) 4WD IndicatorThe SVC 4WD lights will come on when the ignition keyis turned to the ON position and will stay on for 2seconds. If the light stays on or comes on during driving,it means that the 4WD system is not functioning properlyand that service is required.

28. Cruise Light (Speed Control)This indicator lights when the electronic speed controlsystem is turned on.

29. Cargo LampThe Cargo Lamp light will illuminate when the CargoLamp is activated from the headlight control switch,located below the headlight switch.

30. TOW/HAULThe TOW/HAUL button is located at the end of the gearshift lever. This light will illuminate when the TOW/HAUL button has been selected.

158 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 159: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

31. 4LOCK IndicatorIndicates transfer case is in 4LOCK position.

32. Odometer/Trip Odometer ButtonPress this button to toggle between the odometer and thetrip odometer display. Holding the button in resets thetrip odometer reading.

RADIO RECEPTION INFORMATION

AM ReceptionAM radio signals usually travel longer distances than FMsignals, especially at night. These longer distance AMsignals can cause AM stations to interfere with oneanother. Noise from storms and power lines can alsointerfere with AM reception. Reducing the treble canreduce some of the noise.

FM ReceptionFM Stereo signals produce better sound quality than AMsignals. However, FM signals will only travel approxi-mately 10 to 40 miles (16 to 64 km). Tall structures or hillscan cause interference with FM signals causing the soundto cut out.

ELECTRONIC DIGITAL CLOCKThe clock and radio each use the display panel built intothe radio. A digital readout shows the frequency and/ortime in hours and minutes (depending on your radiomodel) whenever the ignition switch is in the “ON” or“ACC” position.

When the ignition switch is in the “OFF” position, orwhen the radio frequency is being displayed, time keep-ing is accurately maintained.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 159

4

Page 160: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

On the AM/FM/CD (6-disc) radio the time button alter-nates the location of the time and frequency on thedisplay. On the AM/FM/CD (single-disc) radio only oneof the two, time or frequency is displayed.

Clock Setting Procedure

1. Press and hold the time button until the hours blink.

2. Adjust the hours by turning the right side Tune /Audio control.

3. After the hours are adjusted, press the right side Tune/ Audio control to set the minutes.

4. Adjust the minutes using the right side Tune / Audiocontrol.

5. To exit, press any button/knob or wait approximately5 seconds.

SALES CODE REF — AM/FM/CD (SINGLE DISC)RADIO WITH OPTIONAL HANDS FREE PHONECAPABILITY

160 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 161: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Operating Instructions - Radio Mode

NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACCposition to operate the radio.

Power Switch/Volume Control (Rotary)Press the ON/VOL control to turn the radio ON. Pressthe ON/VOL a second time to turn OFF the radio.

Electronic Volume ControlThe electronic volume control turns continuously (360degrees) in either direction without stopping. Turning thevolume control to the right increases the volume and tothe left decreases it.

When the audio system is turned on, the sound will beset at the same volume level as last played.

The volume can be turned down, but not up, when theaudio system is off and the ignition is ON.

Mode Button (Radio Mode)Press the mode button repeatedly to select between theCD player or Satellite Radio (if equipped).

SEEK Button (Radio Mode)Press and release the SEEK button to search for the nextlistenable station in either AM/FM or Satellite (ifequipped) mode. Press the right side of the button to seekup and the left side to seek down.The radio will re-mained tuned to the new station until you make anotherselection. Holding the button will bypass stations with-out stopping until you release it.

MUTE Button (Radio Mode)Press the MUTE button to cancel the sound from thespeakers. �MUTE� will be displayed. Press the MUTEbutton a second time and the sound from the speakerswill return. Rotating the volume control, turning theradio ON /OFF, or turning ON/OFF the ignition, willcancel the MUTE feature.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 161

4

Page 162: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: In Hands Free Phone (if equipped) mode, theMUTE button mutes the microphone.

SCAN Button (Radio Mode)Pressing the SCAN button causes the tuner to search forthe next listenable station, in either AM, FM or Satellite (ifequipped) frequencies, pausing for 5 seconds at eachlistenable station before continuing to the next. To stopthe search, press SCAN a second time.

PSCAN Button (Radio Mode)Pressing the PSCAN button, causes the tuner to scanthrough preset stations, in either AM, FM or Satellite (ifequipped) frequencies, pausing for 5 seconds at eachpreset station before continuing to the next. To stop thesearch, press PSCAN a second time.

RW/FF (Radio Mode)Pressing the rewind/fast forward button causes the tunerto search for the next frequency in the direction of thearrows. This feature operates in either AM, FM or Satel-lite (if equipped) frequencies.

TUNE Control (Radio Mode)Turn the right side rotary control to increase or decreasethe frequency.

AM/FM Button (Radio Mode)Press the button to select AM or FM Modes.

Setting the Tone, Balance, and FadePress the rotary TUNE control and BASS will display.Turn the TUNE control to the right or left to increase ordecrease the Bass tones.

Press the rotary TUNE control a second time and MIDwill display. Turn the TUNE control to the right or left toincrease or decrease the Mid Range tones.

162 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 163: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Press the rotary TUNE control a third time and TREBLEwill display. Turn the TUNE control to the right or left toincrease or decrease the Treble tones.

Press the rotary TUNE control a fourth time and BAL willdisplay. Turn the TUNE control to the right or left toadjust the sound level from the right or left side speakers.

Press the rotary TUNE control a fifth time and FADE willdisplay. Turn the TUNE control to the right or left toadjust the sound level between the front and rear speak-ers.

Press the tune control again or wait 5 seconds and theradio will return to normal display.

SET Button (Radio Mode) To SET The Push-ButtonMemoryWhen you are receiving a station that you wish tocommit to push-button memory, press the SET button.The symbol SET 1 will now show in the display window.

Select the button (1-6) you wish to lock onto this stationand press and release that button. If a button is notselected within 5 seconds after pressing the SET button,the station will continue to play but will not be storedinto push-button memory.

You may add a second station to each push-button byrepeating the above procedure with this exception: Pressthe SET button twice and SET 2 will show in the displaywindow. Each button can be set for SET 1 and SET 2 inboth AM and FM. This allows a total of 12 AM,12 FM and12 Satellite (if equipped) stations to be stored into push-button memory. The stations stored in SET 2 memory canbe selected by pressing the push-button twice.

Every time a preset button is used a correspondingbutton number will be displayed.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 163

4

Page 164: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Preset Buttons 1 - 6 (Radio Mode)These buttons tune the Radio to the stations that youcommit to push-button memory {12 AM, 12 FM, and 12Satellite (if equipped) stations}.

Operation Instructions - CD Mode

NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACCposition to operate the radio.

Inserting The Compact Disc (Single CD Player)Gently insert one CD into the CD player with the CDlabel facing up. The CD will automatically be pulled intothe CD Player and the CD icon will illuminate on theradio display.

If the volume control is ON, the unit will switch to CDmode and begin to play. The display will show the tracknumber and play time in minutes and seconds. Play willbegin at the start of track one.

NOTE:• You may insert or eject a disc with the radio or ignition

switch OFF.

• If you insert a disc with the ignition ON and the radioOFF, the CD will automatically be pulled into the CDPlayer and the display will show the time of day.

SEEK Button (CD Mode)Press the right side of the SEEK button for the next trackon the CD. Press the left side of the button to return to thebeginning of the current track, or return to the beginningof the previous track if the CD is within the first 10seconds of the current selection.

MUTE Button ((CD Mode)Press the MUTE button to cancel the sound from thespeakers. �MUTE� will be displayed. Press the MUTEbutton a second time and the sound from the speakerswill return. Rotating the volume control or turning OFFthe ignition will also return the sound from the speakers.

164 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 165: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

SCAN Button (CD Mode)Press this button to play the first 10 seconds of each track.To stop the scan function, press the button a second time.

EJECT Button (CD Mode)Press this button and the disc will unload andmove to the entrance for easy removal. Theunit will switch to the last selected mode.

If you do not remove the disc within 15 seconds, it will bereloaded. The radio mode will continue to appear.

TIME Button (CD Mode)Press this button to change the display from elapsed CDplaying time to time of day.

RW/FF (CD Mode)Press and hold the FF (Fast Forward) and the CD playerwill begin to fast forward until FF is released. The RW(Reverse) button works in a similar manner.

NOTE: RND Button (Random Play Button) (CD Mode)

Press this button while the CD is playing to activateRandom Play. This feature plays the selections on thecompact disc in random order to provide an interestingchange of pace.

Press the SEEK button to move to the next randomlyselected track.

Press and hold the FF button to fast forward through thetracks. Release the FF button to stop the fast forwardfeature. If the RW button is pressed, the current track willreverse to the beginning of the track and begin playing.

Press the RDN button a second time to stop RandomPlay.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 165

4

Page 166: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Operating Instructions - Hands Free Phone — IfEquippedRefer to the HANDS FREE PHONE (UConnect™) sectionof the Owner’s Manual.

SALES CODE RAQ – AM/FM/CD (6-DISC) RADIOWITH OPTIONAL SATELLITE RADIO, HANDSFREE PHONE, AND VIDEO CAPABILITIES

Operating Instructions - Radio Mode

NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACCposition to operate the radio.

Power Switch/Volume Control (Rotary)Press the ON/VOL control to turn the radio ON. Pressthe ON/VOL a second time to turn OFF the radio.

Electronic Volume ControlThe electronic volume control turns continuously (360degrees) in either direction without stopping. Turning thevolume control to the right increases the volume and tothe left decreases it.

When the audio system is turned on, the sound will beset at the same volume level as last played.

The volume can be turned down, but not up, when theaudio system is off and the ignition is ON.

166 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 167: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Mode Button (Radio Mode)Press the mode button repeatedly to select between theRadio, CD player, Hands Free Phone, Satellite, or VehicleEntertainment System (VES) (if equipped).

SEEK Button (Radio Mode)Press and release the SEEK button to search for the nextstation in either AM/FM or Satellite (if equipped) mode.Press the right side of the button to seek up and the leftside to seek down.The radio will remained tuned to thenew station until you make another selection. Holdingthe button and will bypass stations without stoppinguntil you release it.

MUTE Button (Radio Mode)Press the MUTE button to cancel the sound from thespeakers. �MUTE� will be displayed. Press the MUTEbutton a second time and the sound from the speakerswill return. Rotating the volume control or turning OFFthe ignition will also return the sound from the speakers

NOTE: In Hands Free Phone (if equipped) mode, theMUTE button mutes the microphone.

SCAN Button (Radio Mode)Pressing the SCAN button causes the tuner to search forthe next station, in either AM, FM or Satellite (ifequipped) frequencies, pausing for 5 seconds at eachlistenable station before continuing to the next. Pressingthe AM/FM button continues the search in the alternatefrequency band. To stop the search, press SCAN a secondtime.

INFO Button (Radio Mode)Press the INFO button for an RBDS station (one with callletters displayed). The radio will return a Radio Textmessage broadcast from an FM station (FM mode only).

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 167

4

Page 168: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

RW/FF (Radio Mode)Pressing the rewind/fast forward button causes the tunerto search for the next frequency in the direction of thearrows. This feature operates in either AM, FM or Satel-lite (if equipped) frequencies.

TUNE Control (Radio Mode)Turn the right side rotary control to increase or decreasethe frequency.

AM/FM Button (Radio Mode)Press the button to select AM or FM Modes.

Setting the Tone, Balance, and FadePress the rotary TUNE control and BASS will display.Turn the TUNE control to the right or left to increase ordecrease the Bass tones.

Press the rotary TUNE control a second time and MIDwill display. Turn the TUNE control to the right or left toincrease or decrease the Mid Range tones.

Press the rotary TUNE control a third time and TREBLEwill display. Turn the TUNE control to the right or left toincrease or decrease the Treble tones.

Press the rotary TUNE control a fourth time and BAL willdisplay. Turn the TUNE control to the right or left toadjust the sound level from the right or left side speakers.

Press the rotary TUNE control a fifth time and FADE willdisplay. Turn the TUNE control to the right or left toadjust the sound level between the front and rear speak-ers.

Press the rotary TUNE control again to exit setting tone,balance and fade.

RDN/PTY Button (Radio Mode)Pressing this button once will turn on the PTY mode for5 seconds. If no action is taken during the 5 second timeout the PTY icon will turn off. Pressing the PTY button

168 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 169: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

within 5 seconds will allow the program format type tobe selected. Many radio stations do not currently broad-cast PTY information.

Toggle the PTY button to select the following formattypes:

Program Type 16 Digit-Character Dis-play

No program type or un-defined None

News NewsInformation Information

Sports SportsTalk TalkRock Rock

Classic Rock Classic_RockAdult Hits Adult_HitsSoft Rock Soft_Rock

Top 40 Top_40Country CountryOldies Oldies

Soft SoftNostalgia Nostalgia

Jazz JazzClassical Classical

Rhythm and Blues Rhythm_and_BluesSoft Rhythm and Blues Soft_R_&_B

Foreign Language Foreign_LanguageReligious Music Religious_MusicReligious Talk Religious_Talk

Personality PersonalityPublic Public

College CollegeUnassigned

Weather Weather

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 169

4

Page 170: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

By pressing the SEEK button when the PTY icon isdisplayed, the radio will be tuned to the next frequencystation with the same selected PTY name. The PTYfunction only operates when in the FM mode.

If a preset button is activated while in the PTY (ProgramType) mode, the PTY mode will be exited and the radiowill tune to the preset station.

Buttons 1 - 6 (Radio Mode)These buttons tune the Radio to the stations that youcommit to push-button memory {12AM, 12 FM, and 12Satellite (if equipped) stations}.

Operation Instructions - (CD MODE For CD AudioPlay)

NOTE: The ignition switch must be in the ON or ACCposition to operate the radio.

NOTE: Note: This Radio is capable of playing compactdiscs (CD), recordable compact discs (CD-R), rewritablecompact discs (CD-RW) compact discs with MP3 tracksand multisession compact discs with CD and MP3 tracks.

Inserting Compact Disc(s)

CAUTION!

This CD player will accept 4 3/4 inch (12 cm) discsonly. The use of other sized discs may damage theCD player mechanism.

You may eject a disc with the radio OFF.

If you insert a disc with the ignition ON and the radioOFF, the display will show the time of day. If you inserta disc with the ignition OFF, the display will show thetime of day for about 5 seconds, then go out.

170 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 171: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

If you insert a disc with the ignition ON and the radioON, the unit will switch from radio to CD mode andbegin to play when you insert the disc. The display willshow the disc number, the track number, and index timein minutes and seconds. Play will begin at the start oftrack 1.

SEEK Button (CD MODE For CD Audio Play)Press the right side of the SEEK button for the nextselection on the CD. Press the left side of the button toreturn to the beginning of the current selection, or returnto the beginning of the previous selection if the CD iswithin the first 10 seconds of the current selection.

MUTE Button (CD MODE For CD Audio Play)Press the MUTE button to cancel the sound from thespeakers. �MUTE� will be displayed. Press the MUTEbutton a second time and the sound from the speakerswill return. Rotating the volume control or turning OFFthe ignition will also return the sound from the speakers.

SCAN Button (CD MODE For CD Audio Play)Press the Scan button to scan through each track on theCD currently playing.

LOAD/EJECT Button (CD Mode For CD AudioPlay)

LOAD/ EJECT - LoadPress the LOAD/ EJECT button and the push-button with the corresponding number wherethe CD is being loaded. The radio will displayPLEASE WAIT and prompt when to INSERT

DISC. After the radio displays �LOAD DISC� insert theCD into the player.

Radio display will show �LOADING DISC� when the discis loading.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 171

4

Page 172: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

LOAD / EJECT - EjectPress the LOAD/ EJECT button and the push-button with the corresponding number wherethe CD was loaded and the disc will unloadand move to the entrance for easy removal.

Radio display will show �EJECTING DISC� when the discis being ejected and prompt the user to remove the disc.Press and hold the LOAD/ EJECT button to eject all discsin the radio.

If you have ejected a disc and have not removed it within15 seconds, it will be reloaded. If the CD is not removed,the radio will continue to play the non-removed CD. Ifthe CD is removed and there are other CD’s in the radio,the radio will play the next CD. If the CD is removed andthere are no other CD’s in the radio, the radio will remainin CD mode and display �NO DISC LOADED�. The disccan be ejected with the radio and ignition OFF.

TIME Button (CD MODE For CD Audio Play)Press this button to change the display from a large CDplaying time display and small clock time display to alarge clock time display and small CD playing timedisplay.

RW/FF (CD MODE For CD Audio Play)Press FF (Fast Forward) once and the CD player willbegin to fast forward until FF is pressed again or RW oranother CD button is pressed. The RW (Reverse) buttonworks in a similar manner.

TUNE Control (CD MODE For CD Audio Play)Pressing the TUNE control allows the setting of the Tone,Fade, and Balance. See Radio Mode.

AM/FM Button (CD MODE For CD Audio Play)Switches the Radio to the Radio mode.

172 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 173: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

RND/PTY Button (Random Play Button) (CDMODE For CD Audio Play)Press this button while the CD is playing to activateRandom Play. This feature plays the selections on thecompact disc in random order to provide an interestingchange of pace.

Press the SEEK button to move to the next randomlyselected track.

Press and hold the FF button to fast forward through thetracks. Release the FF button to stop the fast forwardfeature. If the RW button is pressed, the current track willreverse to the beginning of the track and begin playing.

Press the RDN button a second time to stop RandomPlay.

BUTTONS 1 - 6 (CD MODE For CD Audio Play)Selects disc positions 1 - 6 for Play/Load/Eject.

Notes On Playing MP3 FilesThe radio can play MP3 files, however, acceptable MP3file recording media and formats are limited. Whenwriting MP3 files, pay attention to the following restric-tions.

Supported media (disc types)The MP3 file recording media supported by the radio areCD-ROM, CD-R and CD-RW.

Supported medium formats (file systems)The medium formats supported by the radio are ISO 9660Level 1 and Level 2 and includes the Joliet extension.When reading discs recorded using formats other thanISO 9660 Level 1 and Level 2, the radio may fail to readfiles properly and may be unable to play the file nor-mally. UDF and Apple HFS formats are not supported.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 173

4

Page 174: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

The radio uses the following limits for file systems:

• Maximum number of directory levels: 15

• Maximum number of files: 255

• Maximum number of folders: 100

• Maximum number of characters in file/folder names:

• Level 1: 12 (including a separator �.� and a3-character extension)

• Level 2: 31 (including a separator �.� and a3-character extension)

Multisession disc formats are supported by the radio.Multisession discs may contain combinations of normalCD audio tracks and computer files (including MP3 files).Discs created with an option such as �keep disc open afterwriting� are most likely multisession discs. The use ofmultisession for CD audio or MP3 playback may result inlonger disc loading times.

Supported MP3 file formatsThe radio will recognize only files with the *.mp3 exten-sion as MP3 files. Non-MP3 files named with the *.mp3extension may cause playback problems. The radio isdesigned to recognize the file as an invalid MP3 and willnot play the file.

When using the MP3 encoder to compress audio data toan MP3 file, the bit rate and sampling frequencies in thefollowing table are supported. In addition, variable bitrates (VBR) are also supported. The majority of MP3 filesuse a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and a 192, 160, 128, 96 orVBR bit rates.

174 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 175: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

MPEG Specifi-cation

Sampling Fre-quency (kHz) Bit rate (kbps)

MPEG-1 AudioLayer 3 48, 44.1, 32

320, 256, 224,192, 160, 128,

112, 96, 80, 64,56, 48, 40, 32

MPEG-2 AudioLayer 3 24, 22.05, 16

160, 128, 144,112, 96, 80, 64,

56, 48, 40, 32, 24,16, 8

ID3 Tag information for artist, song title and album titleare supported for version 1 ID3 tags. ID3 version 2 is notsupported by the radios.

Playlist files are not supported. MP3 Pro files are notsupported.

Playback of MP3 filesWhen a medium containing MP3 data is loaded, theradio checks all files on the medium. If the mediumcontains a lot of folders or files, the radio will take moretime to start playing the MP3 files.

Loading times for playback of MP3 files may be affectedby the following:

• Media - CD-RW media may take longer to load thanCD-R media

• Medium formats - Multisession discs may take longerto load than non-multisession discs

• Number of files and folders - Loading times willincrease with more files and folders

To increase the speed of disc loading, it is recommendedto use CD-R media and single-session discs. To create asingle-session disc, enable the Disc at Once option beforewriting to the disc.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 175

4

Page 176: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Operation Instructions - (CD Mode For MP3 AudioPlay)

SEEK Button (CD Mode For MP3 Play)Pressing the right side of the SEEK button plays the nextMP3 File. Pressing the left side of the SEEK button playsthe beginning of the MP3 file. Pressing the button withinthe first ten seconds plays the previous file.

LOAD/EJECT Button (CD Mode For MP3 Play)

LOAD/ EJECT - LoadPress the LOAD/ EJECT button and the push-button with the corresponding number wherethe CD is being loaded. The radio will displayPLEASE WAIT and prompt when to INSERT

DISC. After the radio displays �LOAD DISC� insert theCD into the player.

Radio display will show �LOADING DISC� when the discis loading.

LOAD / EJECT - EjectPress the LOAD/ EJECT button and the push-button with the corresponding number wherethe CD was loaded and the disc will unloadand move to the entrance for easy removal.

Radio display will show �EJECTING DISC� when the discis being ejected and prompt the user to remove the disc.Press and hold the LOAD/ EJECT button to eject all discsin the radio.

If you have ejected a disc and have not removed it within15 seconds, it will be reloaded. If the CD is not removed,the radio will continue to play the non-removed CD. Ifthe CD is removed and there are other CD’s in the radio,the radio will play the next CD. If the CD is removed andthere are no other CD’s in the radio, the radio will remainin CD mode and display �NO DISC LOADED.�

176 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 177: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

INFO Button (CD Mode For MP3 Play)Press and INFO button while playing MP3 disc. Theradio scrolls through the following TAG information:Song Title, Artist, File Name, and Folder Name (if avail-able).

Press the INFO button once more to return to �elapsedtime� priority mode.

Press and hold the INFO button while in the messagedisplay priority mode or elapsed time display prioritymode will display the song title for each file.

RW/FF (CD Mode For MP3 Play)Press the FF side of the button to move forward throughthe MP3 selection.

TUNE Control (CD Mode For MP3 Play)Pressing the TUNE Control allows the adjustment ofTone, Balance, and Fade.

AM/FM Button (CD Mode For MP3 Play)Switches back to Radio mode.

RND/ PTY Button (CD Mode For MP3 Play)Pressing this button plays files randomly.

SET/DIR Button (CD Mode For MP3 Play)Press the SET/DIR Button to display folders, whenplaying an MP3 discs that have a file/folder structure.Turn the TUNE control to display available folders ormove through available folders. Press the TUNE controlto select a folder.

Buttons 1 - 6 (CD Mode For MP3 Play)Selects disc positions 1 - 6 for Play/Load/Eject.

Operating Instructions - Hands Free Phone (IfEquipped)Refer to Hands Free Phone section of the Owner’sManual.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 177

4

Page 178: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Operating Instructions - Satellite Radio Mode (IfEquipped)Refer to the Satellite Radio section of the Owner’sManual.

Operating Instructions - Video EntertainmentSystem (VES�) (If Equipped)Refer to separate Video Entertainment System (VES�)Guide.

SATELLITE RADIO — IF EQUIPPEDSatellite radio uses direct satellite to receiver broadcast-ing technology to provide clear digital sound, coast tocoast. The subscription service provider is Sirius™ Satel-lite Radio. This service offers over 100 channels of music,sports, news, entertainment, and programming for chil-dren, directly from its satellites and broadcasting studios.

System ActivationTo activate your Sirius Satellite Radio service, call thetoll-free number 888-539-7474, or visit the Sirius web siteat www.sirius.com. Please have the following informa-tion available when activating your system:

1. The Electronic Serial Number/Sirius IdentificationNumber (ESN/SID).

2. Credit card information.

3. Your Vehicle Identification Number.

Electronic Serial Number/Sirius IdentificationNumber (ESN/SID)The Electronic Serial Number/Sirius Identification Num-ber is needed to activate your Sirius Satellite Radio system.To access the ESN/SID, refer to the following steps:

ESN/SID Access with REC RadiosRefer to the “Navigation User’s Manual” for details onsatellite radio operation.

178 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 179: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

ESN/SID Access with REF RadiosWith the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY position andthe radio OFF, press the Eject or CD Eject (depending onthe radio type) and Time buttons simultaneously for 3seconds. The first four digits of the twelve-digit ESN/SIDnumber will be displayed. Press the SEEK UP button todisplay the next four digits. Continue to press the SEEKUP button until all twelve ESN/SID digits have beendisplayed. The SEEK DOWN will page down until thefirst four digits are displayed. The radio will exit theESN/SID mode when any other button is pushed, theignition is turned OFF, or 5 minutes has passed since anybutton was pushed.

ESN/SID Access with RAQ RadiosWith the ignition switch in the ACCESSORY position andthe radio OFF, press the CD Eject and TIME buttonssimultaneously for 3 seconds. All twelve ESN/SID num-bers will be displayed. The radio will exit the ESN/SIDmode when any other button is pushed, the ignition isturned OFF, or 5 minutes has passed since any buttonwas pushed.

Selecting Satellite Mode in REF RadiosPress the MODE button repeatedly until �S A� appears inthe display. A CD may remain in the radio while in theSatellite radio mode.

Selecting Satellite Mode in RAQ RadiosPress the MODE button repeatedly until the word�SIRIUS� appears in the display. These radios will alsodisplay the following:

• After 3 seconds, the current channel name and channelnumber will be displayed for 5 seconds.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 179

4

Page 180: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• The current program type and channel number willthen be displayed for 5 seconds.

• The current channel number will then be displayeduntil an action occurs.

A CD may remain in the radio while in the Satellite radiomode.

Selecting a ChannelPress and release the SEEK or TUNE buttons to search forthe next channel. Press the top of the button to search upand the bottom of the button to search down. Holding theTUNE button causes the radio to bypass channels untilthe button is released.

Press and release the SCAN button (if equipped) toautomatically change channels every 7 seconds. Theradio will pause on each channel for 7 seconds beforemoving on to the next channel. The word �SCAN� will

appear in the display between each channel change. Pressthe SCAN button a second time to stop the search.

NOTE: Channels that may contain objectionable contentcan be blocked. Contact Sirius Customer Care at 888-539-7474 to discuss options for channel blocking or unblock-ing. Please have your ESN/SID information available.

Storing and Selecting Pre-Set ChannelsIn addition to the 10 AM and 10 FM pre-set stations, youmay also commit 10 satellite stations to push buttonmemory. These satellite channel pre-set stations will noterase any AM or FM pre-set memory stations. Follow thememory pre-set procedures that apply to your radio.

Using the PTY (Program Type) Button — IfEquippedFollow the PTY button instructions that apply to yourradio.

180 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 181: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

PTY Button �SCAN�When the desired program type is obtained, press the�SCAN� button within five seconds. The radio will play 7seconds of the selected channel before moving to the nextchannel of the selected program type. Press the �SCAN�button a second time to stop the search.

NOTE: Pressing the �SEEK� or �SCAN� button whileperforming a music type scan will change the channel byone and stop the search. Pressing a pre-set memorybutton during a music type scan, will call up the memorychannel and stop the search.

PTY Button �SEEK�When the desired program is obtained, press the �SEEK�button within five seconds. The channel will change tothe next channel that matches the program type selected.

Satellite AntennaTo ensure optimum reception on vehicles available witha luggage rack, do not place items on the roof around therooftop antenna location. Metal objects placed within theline of sight of the antenna will cause decreased perfor-mance. Larger luggage items should be placed as farforward as possible. Do not place items directly on orabove the antenna.

Reception QualitySatellite reception may be interrupted due to one of thefollowing reasons.

• The vehicle is parked in an underground parkingstructure or under a physical obstacle.

• Dense tree coverage may interrupt reception.

• Driving under wide bridges or along tall buildings cancause intermittent reception.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 181

4

Page 182: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• Placing objects over or too close to the antenna cancause signal blockage.

REMOTE SOUND SYSTEM CONTROLS — IFEQUIPPEDThe remote sound system controls are located on the rearsurface of the steering wheel. Reach behind the wheel toaccess the switches.

The right hand control is a rocker type switch with a pushbutton in the center. Pressing the top of the switch willincrease the volume and pressing the bottom of theswitch will decrease the volume.

The button located in the center of the right hand controlwill switch modes to Radio or CD.

The left hand control is a rocker type switch with a pushbutton in the center. The function of the left hand controlis different depending on which mode you are in.

The following describes the left hand control operation ineach mode.

Radio OperationPressing the top of the switch will SEEK up for the nextlistenable station and pressing the bottom of the switchwill SEEK down for the next listenable station.

182 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 183: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

The button located in the center of the left hand controlwill tune to the next pre-set station that you haveprogrammed in the radio pre-set push-buttons.

CD PlayerPressing the top of the switch once will go to the nexttrack on the CD. Pressing the bottom of the switch oncewill go to the beginning of the current track or to thebeginning of the previous track if it is within one secondafter the current track begins to play.

If you press the switch up or down twice it plays thesecond track, three times, it will play the third, etc.

The button in the center of the left hand switch changesCD’s on the 6–Disc in-dash CD changer radio. Thisbutton does not function for all other radios.

COMPACT DISC MAINTENANCETo keep the compact discs in good condition, take thefollowing precautions:

1. Handle the disc by its edge; avoid touching thesurface.

2. If the disc is stained, clean the surface with a soft cloth,wiping from center to edge.

3. Do not apply paper or tape to the disc; avoid scratch-ing the disc.

4. Do not use solvents such as benzine, thinner, cleaners,or antistatic sprays.

5. Store the disc in its case after playing.

6. Do not expose the disc to direct sunlight.

7. Do not store the disc where temperatures may becometoo high.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 183

4

Page 184: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: If you experience difficulty in playing a particu-lar disc, it may be damaged (i.e. scratched, reflectivecoating removed, a hair, moisture or dew on the disc)oversized, or have theft protection encoding. Try aknown good disc before considering disc player service.

RADIO OPERATION AND CELLULAR PHONESUnder certain conditions, the cellular phone being On inyour vehicle can cause erratic or noisy performance fromyour radio. This condition may be lessened or eliminatedby relocating the cellular phone antenna. This conditionis not harmful to the radio. If your radio performancedoes not satisfactorily “clear” by the repositioning of theantenna, it is recommended that the radio volume beturned down or off during cellular phone operation.

CLIMATE CONTROLSThe controls for the heating and ventilation system in thisvehicle consist of a series of rotary knobs. These comfortcontrols can be set to obtain desired interior conditions.

Air Conditioning And Heater

184 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 185: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Air Conditioning And Heater OperationTo turn on the Air Conditioning, set the fan control at anyspeed and press the snowflake button located at the rightof the control panel. Conditioned air will be directedthrough the outlets selected by the mode control. A lightat the top of the snowflake button shows that the airconditioning is on. Press the button a second time to turnthe air conditioning off.

Slight changes in engine speed or power may be noticedwhen the air conditioning compressor is on. This is anormal occurrence as the compressor will cycle on andoff to maintain comfort and increase fuel economy.

The mode control (at the right of thecontrol panel) can be set in any of thefollowing positions:

NOTE: To improve your selection choices, the systemallows you to operate at intermediate positions betweenthe major modes. These intermediate positions are iden-tified by the small dots.

Recirculation Modes (Panel or Bi-Level )Select the recirculation modes whenthe outside air contains dust, odors,high humidity, or if rapid cooling isdesired. This feature allows for recir-culation of interior air only. Air flowsthrough either the panel outlets orboth the panel and floor outlets, to-

gether, depending wich recirculation mode is selected.

Panel (Fresh Air Modes)Outside air flows through the outlets located in theinstrument panel.

Mode Control

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 185

4

Page 186: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Bi-LevelOutside air flows through the outlets located in theinstrument panel and at the floor.

FloorOutside air flows primarily through the floor out-lets located under the instrument panel.

MixOutside air flows in equal proportions through thefloor and defroster outlets.

DefrostOutside air is primarily directed to the windshieldthrough the defroster outlets located at the base of

the windshield, and the demister outlets located at theedge of each side of the instrument panel.

Blower ControlThe rotary knob on the left ofthe control panel is theblower control. Turn the knobclockwise to one of the fourpositions to obtain the blowerspeed you desire.

186 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 187: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Temperature ControlThe rotary knob at the centerof the control panel controlsthe temperature of the inte-rior air. You can choose yourdegree of comfort by rotatingthe knob. The coldest tem-perature setting is to the ex-treme left (blue region) andthe warmest setting is to theextreme right (red region) of

the rotation.

CirculationThe cab is designed with features to promote outside aircirculation. There are grilles in the cab back panel. Theseare air exhausters that provide the means for regularexchange of cab air.

Side window demisters direct air flow specifically to thewindow glass to help prevent interior fogging of theglass. They are located in the extreme outside upperedges of the instrument panel. The demisters also pro-vide extra air ducts for circulation. They are in operationwhenever the Floor, Mix or Defrost modes are in use.

NOTE: When you turn off the engine you may hear ahissing sound from under the hood for a short period oftime. This is a normal condition that occurs if the airconditioning system has been on. It is not an indication ofa problem with the air conditioning system.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 187

4

Page 188: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Operating Tips

Fast CooldownFor a fast cooldown, turn the blower fan rotary knob tothe extreme right position, turn the mode control to thepanel fresh position, press the snowflake button to turnon the air conditioning, and drive with the windowsopen for the first few minutes. Once the hot air has beenexpelled, close the windows and turn the mode selectorto the Recirculation Panel Mode or Recirculation ModeBi-level position. When a comfortable condition has beenreached, choose a mode position and adjust the tempera-ture control knob and blower speed as necessary tomaintain comfort. For high humidity conditions it maybe necessary to remain in the Recirculation mode tomaintain comfort.

Window FoggingWindows will fog on the inside when the humidity insidethe vehicle is high. This often occurs in mild or cooltemperatures when it’s rainy or humid. In most casesturning on the Air-conditioning (pressing the snowflakebutton) will clear the fog. Adjust the temperature control,air direction and blower speed to maintain comfort.

As the temperature gets colder it may be necessary todirect air onto the windshield by using MIX Modeposition on the control. Adjust the temperature controland blower speed to maintain comfort. High blowerspeeds will reduce fogging. Interior fogging on thewindshield can be quickly removed by selecting thedefrost mode.

188 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 189: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Regular cleaning of the inside of the windows with anon-filming cleaning solution (vinegar and water worksvery well) will help prevent contaminates (cigarettesmoke, perfumes, etc.) from sticking to the windows.Contaminates on the inside of windows can increase therate of window fogging.

Summer OperationAir conditioned vehicles must be protected with a highquality antifreeze coolant during summer to provideproper corrosion protection and to raise the boiling pointof the coolant for protection against overheating. A 50%concentration of engine coolant to distilled water isrecommended. See coolant section of Owner’s manual.

When using the air conditioner in extremely heavy trafficin hot weather especially when towing a trailer, addi-tional engine cooling may be required. If this situation isencountered, operate the transmission in a lower gear.When stopped in heavy traffic, it may be necessary toshift into NEUTRAL and depress the accelerator slightlyfor fast idle operation.

Winter OperationWhen operating the system during the winter months,make sure the air intake, located directly in front of thewindshield, is free of ice, slush, snow, or other obstruc-tions.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 189

4

Page 190: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Operation Tips Chart

190 INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS

Page 191: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

REAR WINDOW DEFROSTER – IF EQUIPPED

CAUTION!

Use care when washing the inside of the rear win-dow to prevent damage to heating elements. Use asoft cloth and a mild washing solution, wipingparallel to the heating elements. Also, keep allobjects a safe distance from the window to preventdamaging the heating elements.

A push-button type switch is located on the rightside of the control below the A/C (Snowflake)

button. Pressing the switch will turn on the Rear WindowDefroster and heated mirrors, if equipped. A light abovethe Rear Window Defroster symbol will illuminate toindicate the Rear Window Defroster is On. Pushing thebutton again will turn the Rear Window Defroster Offprior to the time-out. The Rear Window Defroster willturn off automatically after 15 minutes after the firstpush, 10 minutes after the second push and 5 minutesafter the third push and all subsequent pushes of thebutton (all within the same ignition cycle). To preventexcessive battery drain, use the rear defroster only whenthe engine is running.

INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONTROLS 191

4

Page 192: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys
Page 193: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

STARTING AND OPERATING

CONTENTS

� Starting Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197

▫ Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197

▫ Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197

▫ Normal Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198

▫ Engine Block Heater — If Equipped . . . . . . . . 199

� Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200

▫ Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200

� Four-Wheel Drive Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207

▫ NV233/243 Gii Transfer Case OperatingInformation/Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207

▫ Shifting Procedure -NV233/243 Transfer Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210

▫ NV244 Transfer Case Operating Information /Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212

▫ Shifting Procedure - NV244 Transfer Case . . . . 216

� Limited-Slip Rear Axle Differential—If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219

� Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220

5

Page 194: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

� Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221

▫ Rear Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System —(If Equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222

▫ Four-Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System —If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222

� Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224

� Rocking The Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224

� Tire Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225

▫ Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225

▫ Tire Identification Number (TIN) . . . . . . . . . . 228

▫ Tire Loading And Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . 229

� Tires—General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233

▫ Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233

▫ Tire Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234

▫ Radial-Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236

▫ Compact Spare Tire — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . 237

▫ Limited Use Spare — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . 238

▫ Tire Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238

▫ Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239

▫ Life Of Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240

▫ Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240

▫ Alignment And Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241

� Supplemental Tire Pressure Information . . . . . . . 242

� Tire Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242

� Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243

� Tire Rotation Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . 244

194 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 195: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

� Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245

▫ Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246

▫ Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246

▫ MMT In Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246

▫ Materials Added To Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247

▫ Adding Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247

▫ Fuel System Cautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249

▫ Carbon Monoxide Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250

� Catalytic Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250

� Vehicle Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252

▫ Certification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252

▫ Curb Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253

▫ Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253

� Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255

▫ Common Towing Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255

▫ Trailer Hitch Classification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258

▫ Trailer Towing Weights(Maximum Trailer Weight Ratings) . . . . . . . . . 259

▫ Trailer And Tongue Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259

▫ Towing Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260

▫ Towing Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264

▫ Trailer Towing Mirrors — If Equipped . . . . . . 266

� Snowplow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266

▫ Dodge Dakota Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266

STARTING AND OPERATING 195

5

Page 196: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

� Recreational Towing (Behind Motorhome, Etc.) . . 267

▫ Recreational Towing 2WD Models . . . . . . . . . 267

▫ Recreational Towing 4WD Models . . . . . . . . . 268

� Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273

� Equipment Identification Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273

196 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 197: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

STARTING PROCEDURESThe starter should not be operated for more than 15second intervals. Waiting a few seconds between suchintervals will protect the starter from overheating.

Manual TransmissionApply the parking brake, place the gearshift control leverin NEUTRAL and depress clutch pedal to the floor beforestarting the vehicle. This vehicle is equipped with aclutch interlocking ignition system. It will not start unlessthe clutch is depressed.

Automatic TransmissionStart the engine with the shift lever in NEUTRAL orPARK position. Apply the brake before shifting to anydriving range.

WARNING!

Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to get itstarted. Vehicles equipped with an automatic trans-mission cannot be started this way. Unburned fuelcould enter the catalytic converter and once theengine has started, ignite and damage the converterand vehicle. If the vehicle has a discharged battery,booster cables may be used to obtain a start from abooster battery or the battery in another vehicle. Thistype of start can be dangerous if done improperly.See section 6 of this manual for the proper jumpstarting procedures and follow them carefully.

STARTING AND OPERATING 197

5

Page 198: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Normal StartingNormal starting of either a warm or cold engine isobtained without pumping or depressing the acceleratorpedal. Turn the key to the START position and releasewhen the engine starts. If the engine fails to start within10 seconds, turn the key to the OFF position, wait 5seconds, then repeat the starting procedure.

If Engine Fails To StartIf the engine fails to start after you have followed theNormal Starting procedure, it may be flooded. Push theaccelerator pedal all the way to the floor and hold it therewhile cranking the engine. This should clear any excessfuel in case the engine is flooded.

CAUTION!

To prevent damage to the starter, do not crank theengine for more than 15 seconds at a time. Wait 10 to15 seconds before trying again.

If the engine has been flooded, it may start to run, but nothave enough power to continue running when the key isreleased. If this occurs, continue cranking with the accel-erator pedal pushed all the way to the floor. Release theaccelerator pedal and the key once the engine is runningsmoothly.

If the engine shows no sign of starting after two 15second periods of cranking with the accelerator pedalheld to the floor, the Normal Starting procedure shouldbe repeated.

198 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 199: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Never pour fuel or other flammable liquid into thethrottle body air inlet opening in an attempt to startthe vehicle. This could result in a flash fire, causingserious personal injury.

After StartingThe idle speed is automatically controlled on fuel injectedengines and will decrease as the engine warms up.

CAUTION!

Long periods of engine idling can cause excessiveexhaust temperatures which can damage your ve-hicle. Do not leave your vehicle unattended with theengine running.

WARNING!

Do not leave children or animals inside parkedvehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build up maycause serious injury or death.

Engine Block Heater — If EquippedThe engine block heater warms engine coolant andpermits quicker starts in cold weather. Connect the cordto a standard 110-115 volt AC electrical outlet with agrounded, three wire extension cord.

The engine block heater cord is located at the right frontof the engine compartment for all engine applications.

STARTING AND OPERATING 199

5

Page 200: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Remember to disconnect the cord before driving.Damage to the 110-115 volt electrical cord couldcause electrocution.

AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION

Automatic TransmissionThe electronic PRNDL on the instrument cluster indicatesthe transmission gear selected. The selector lever ismounted on the right side of the steering column. Todrive, move the selector lever from Park or Neutral to thedesired drive position. Pull selector lever toward youwhen shifting into Reverse, Second, First or Park, orwhen shifting out of Park.

Brake/Transmission Interlock SystemThis system prevents you from moving the gear shift outof Park and into any gear unless the brake pedal ispressed. This system is active only while the ignitionswitch is in the ON position. Always depress the brakepedal first, before moving the gear selector out of PARK.

Gear RangesDO NOT race the engine when shifting from Park orNeutral position into another gear range.

“P” ParkSupplements parking brake by locking the transmission.Engine can be started in this range. Never use Park whilevehicle is in motion. Apply parking brake when leavingvehicle in this range. Always apply parking brake first,then place selector in Park position.

200 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 201: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Your vehicle could move and injure you and others ifit is not completely in P (Park). Check by trying tomove the gearshift lever back and forth without firstpulling the lever toward you, after you have set it inP (Park). Make sure it is in Park before leaving thevehicle.

WARNING!

Never use Park position on an automatic transmis-sion as a substitute for the parking brake. Alwaysapply parking brake fully when parked to guardagainst vehicle movement and possible injury ordamage.

WARNING!

It is dangerous to shift the selector lever out of “P” or“N” if the engine speed is higher than idle speed. Ifyour foot is not firmly on the brake pedal, thevehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in re-verse. You could lose control of the vehicle and hitsomeone or something. Only shift into gear whenthe engine is idling normally and when your rightfoot is firmly on the brake pedal.

“R” ReverseUse this range only after the vehicle has come to acomplete stop.

STARTING AND OPERATING 201

5

Page 202: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

“N” NeutralShift to Neutral when vehicle is standing for prolongedperiods with engine running. Engine may be started inthis range. Set the parking brake if you must leave thevehicle.

“D” DriveFor most city and highway driving.

“2” SecondFor driving slowly in heavy city traffic or on mountainroads where more precise speed control is desirable. Useit also when climbing long grades, and for engine brak-ing when descending moderately steep grades. To pre-vent excessive engine speed do not exceed 45 miles perhour (72 km/h) in this range.

“1” FirstFor driving up very steep hills and for engine braking atlow speeds 25 mph (40 km/h) or less when going downhill. To prevent excessive engine speed do not exceed 25mph (40 km/h) in this range.

Overdrive OperationThe overdrive automatic transmission contains an elec-tronically controlled fourth and fifth (if equipped) speed(Overdrive). The transmission will automatically shiftfrom Drive to Overdrive if the following conditions arepresent:

• the transmission selector is in Drive;

• the engine coolant has reached normal operating tem-perature;

• vehicle speed is above approximately 30 mph (48km/h);

• the “TOW/HAUL” switch has not been activated;

202 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 203: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• transmission has reached normal operating tempera-ture.

NOTE: If the vehicle is started in extremely cold tem-peratures, the transmission may not shift into Overdriveand will automatically select the most desirable gear foroperation at this temperature. Normal operation willresume when the transmission fluid temperature hasrisen to a suitable level. Refer also to the Note undertorque converter clutch, later in this section.

If the transmission temperature gets extremely hot, thetransmission will automatically select the most desirablegear for operation at this temperature. If the transmissiontemperature becomes hot enough the TRANS TEMP lightmay illuminate and the transmission may downshift outof Overdrive until the transmission cools down. Aftercooldown, the transmission will resume normal opera-tion.

The transmission will downshift from Overdrive to Driveif the accelerator pedal is fully depressed at vehiclespeeds above approximately 35 mph (56 km/h).

When To Use “TOW/HAUL” Mode

When driving in hilly areas, towing a trailer, carrying aheavy load, etc., and frequent transmission shifting oc-curs, press the “TOW/HAUL” button. This will improve

STARTING AND OPERATING 203

5

Page 204: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

performance and reduce the potential for transmissionoverheating or failure due to excessive shifting. Whenoperating in “TOW/HAUL” mode, 5th gear (ifequipped) is disabled and 2-3 and 3-4 shift patterns aremodified. Shifts into Overdrive (4th gear) are allowedduring steady cruise (for improved fuel economy) andautomatic closed-throttle downshifts to 3rd gear (forimproved braking) will occur during steady braking.

The “TOW/HAUL” light will illuminate in the instru-ment cluster to indicate when the switch has beenactivated. Pressing the switch a second time restoresnormal operation. If the “TOW/HAUL” mode is desired,the button must be pressed each time the engine isstarted.

Torque Converter ClutchA feature designed to improve fuel economy is includedin all automatic transmissions. A clutch within the torqueconverter engages automatically at a calibrated speed at

light throttle. It engages at higher speeds under heavieracceleration. This may result in a slightly different feelingor response during normal operation in high gear. Whenthe vehicle speed drops below a calibrated speed, orduring acceleration, the clutch automatically andsmoothly disengages. The feature is operational in Over-drive and in Drive.

NOTE: The torque converter clutch will not engageuntil the transmission fluid and engine coolant are warm[usually after 1-3 miles (1.6 - 4.8 km) of driving]. Becausethe engine speed is higher when the torque converterclutch is not engaged, it may seem as if the transmissionis not shifting into Overdrive when cold. This is normal.Pressing the�TOW/HAUL� button, when the transmis-sion is sufficiently warm, will demonstrate that thetransmission is able to shift into and out of Overdrive.

NOTE: If the vehicle has not been driven in severaldays, the first few seconds of operation after shifting the

204 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 205: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

transmission into gear may seem sluggish. This is due tothe fluid partially draining from the torque converter intothe transmission. This condition is normal and will notcause damage to the transmission. The torque converterwill refill within five seconds of shifting from Park intoany other gear position.

Manual Transmission — 6-Speed

NOTE: The parking brake should be engaged beforeleaving the vehicle, especially on an incline.

This model is equipped with a clutch interlocking igni-tion system. The clutch pedal must be fully depressed tostart the vehicle.

Fully depress the clutch pedal before shifting gears. Asyou release the clutch pedal, lightly depress the accelera-tor pedal. When launching a stationary vehicle, keep theengine speed low until the clutch is fully engaged.

NOTE: Damage to the clutch can result from starting in2nd or 3rd gear with a loaded vehicle. Use each gear innumerical order – do not skip a gear.

When shifting from 5th to 6th gear, do not apply exces-sive knob load toward the Reverse gear gate, as you mayoverpower Reverse crash-through load and unintention-ally clash into Reverse gear. Also, when shifting from 6thto 5th gear, excessive knob load toward the Reverse geargate will result in blocking of the shift.

To shift into Reverse, come to a complete stop. Depressthe clutch and pause briefly to allow the gear train tostop. Reverse has a �crash-through� lockout feature. Inorder to get into the reverse gate you should start inneutral 3/4 and move rapidly into the reverse gate in oneswift motion. If you move slowly toward reverse you willencounter a very high load which makes it difficult toenter the gate.

STARTING AND OPERATING 205

5

Page 206: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Never drive with your foot resting on the clutch pedal, orattempt to hold the vehicle on a hill with the clutch pedalpartially engaged, as this will cause abnormal wear onthe clutch.

Recommended Shift SpeedsTo use your manual transmission for fuel economy itshould be upshifted as listed below. Shift at the vehiclespeeds listed for acceleration. Earlier upshifts duringcruise conditions (relatively steady speeds) will result inincreased fuel economy, and may be used as indicated.

Higher upshift speeds may be used to obtain a desiredacceleration rate.

6 Speed Manual Transmission Shift Speed in mph (km/h)

En-gine Model Axle

Accel-eration

Rate1 to

22 to

33 to

44 to

55 to

6

3.7L ALL3.21&

3.55

ACCEL&

CRUISE

15(24)10

(16)

24(39)19

(31)

34(55)27

(44)

47(76)37

(60)

56(90)41

(66)

4.7L All3.21&

3.55

ACCEL&

CRUISE15

(24)25

(40)40

(65)45

(72)50

(81)

DownshiftingMoving from a high gear down to a lower gear isrecommended to preserve brakes when driving downsteep hills. In addition, downshifting at the right timeprovides better acceleration when you desire to resumespeed. For acceleration at speeds less than 20 mph (30km/h), 2nd gear is recommended.

206 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 207: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

CAUTION!

When descending a hill, be very careful to downshiftone gear at a time to prevent overspeeding theengine which can cause valve damage.

FOUR-WHEEL DRIVE OPERATION

NV233/243 GII Transfer Case OperatingInformation/PrecautionsThe NV233/243 is an electric shift transfer case and isoperated by the 4WD Control Switch (Transfer CaseSwitch), which is located on the instrument panel.

The NV233/243 transfer case provides 4 mode positions:2 (rear) wheel drive high range, 4 wheel drive high range,4 wheel drive low range, and neutral.

The NV233/243 transfer case is designed to be driven inthe 2 wheel drive position (2WD) for normal street andhighway conditions (dry hard surfaced roads).

When additional traction is required, the transfer case4HI and 4LO positions can be used to lock the front andrear driveshafts together and force the front and rearwheels to rotate at the same speed. This is accomplishedby rotating the 4WD Control Switch to the desiredposition - see Shifting Procedure section for specificshifting instructions. The 4HI and 4LO positions aredesigned for loose or slippery road surfaces only. Drivingin the 4HI and 4LO positions on dry hard-surfaced roadsmay cause increased tire wear and damage to the driv-eline components.

The transfer case Neutral (N) position is selected bydepressing the recessed button located on the lower lefthand corner of the 4WD Control Switch.

STARTING AND OPERATING 207

5

Page 208: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: The transfer case Neutral (N) position is to beused for recreational towing only. See Recreational Tow-ing section for specific procedures on shifting into andout of Neutral (N).

Transfer Case Position Indicator LightsTransfer case position indicator lights are located on theinstrument cluster. If there is no indicator light on orflashing, the transfer case position is two-wheel drive(2WD). If the indicator light is on, the desired position(4HI or 4LO) has been obtained.

If One or More Shift Requirements are not Met:

1. An indicator light will flash.

2. The transfer case will not shift.

NOTE: Before retrying a selection, make certain that allthe necessary requirements for selecting a new transfercase position have been met. To retry the selection, turnthe control knob back to the current position, wait five (5)

seconds, and retry selection. To find the shift require-ments, refer to the �Shifting Procedure� for your transfercase, located in this section of the owner’s manual.

The “SVC 4WD” warning light monitors the electric shift4WD system. If this light remains on after engine start upor illuminates during driving, it means that the 4WDsystem is not functioning properly and that service isrequired.

WARNING!

Always engage the parking brake when poweringdown the vehicle if the �SVC 4WD� light is illumi-nated. Not engaging the parking brake may allowthe vehicle to roll, which may cause personal injury.

208 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 209: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: Do not attempt to make a shift while only thefront or rear wheels are spinning. The NV233/243 trans-fer case is not equipped with a synchronizer and there-fore the front and rear driveshaft speeds must be equalfor the shift to take place. Shifting while only the front orrear wheels are spinning can cause damage to the trans-fer case.

When operating your vehicle in 4LO, the engine speed isapproximately three times that of the 2WD or 4HIpositions at a given road speed. Take care not to over-speed the engine and do not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).

Proper operation of 4 wheel drive vehicles depends ontires of equal size, type and circumference on each wheel.Any difference in tire size can cause damage to thetransfer case.

Because 4 wheel drive provides improved traction, thereis a tendency to exceed safe turning and stopping speeds.Do not go faster than road conditions permit.

WARNING!

You or others could be injured if you leave thevehicle unattended with the transfer case in theNeutral (N) position without first fully engaging theparking brake. The transfer case Neutral (N) positiondisengages both the front and rear driveshafts fromthe powertrain and will allow the vehicle to moveregardless of the transmission position. The parkingbrake should always be applied when the driver isnot in the vehicle.

For additional information on the appropriate use of eachtransfer case mode position see the information below:

2WDRear Wheel Drive High Range - Normal street andhighway driving. Dry hard surfaced roads.

STARTING AND OPERATING 209

5

Page 210: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

4HI4 Wheel Drive High Range - Locks the front and reardriveshafts together. Forces the front and rear wheels torotate at the same speed. Additional traction for loose orslippery road surfaces only.

4LO4 Wheel Drive Low Range - Low speed 4 wheel drive.Locks the front and rear driveshafts together. Forces thefront and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed.Additional traction and maximum pulling power forloose or slippery road surfaces only. Do not exceed 25mph (40 km/h).

NNeutral - Disengages both the front and rear driveshaftsfrom the powertrain. To be used for flat towing behindanother vehicle. See Recreational Towing for more infor-mation.

Shifting Procedure - NV233/243 Transfer Case

NOTE: If any of the requirements to select a new transfercase position have not been met, the transfer case will notshift, the indicator light for the previous position willremain ON, and the newly selected position indicator lightwill continue to flash until all the requirements for theselected position have been met. To retry a shift: return the

210 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 211: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

control knob back to the original position, make certain allshift requirements have been met, wait five (5) seconds andtry the shift again.

2WD to 4HI or 4HI to 2WDRotate the 4WD Control Switch to the desired position.Shifts between 2WD and 4HI can be done with thevehicle stopped or in motion. With the vehicle in motion,the transfer case will engage / disengage faster if youmomentarily release the accelerator pedal after turningthe control switch. If the vehicle is stopped, the ignitionkey must be in the ON position with the engine eitherRUNNING or OFF. This shift cannot be completed if thekey is in the accessory position.

NOTE: On vehicles equipped with Anti-Lock BrakeSystems, the 4x4 system will not allow shifts between2WD/ 4HI if the rear wheels are spinning (no traction). Inthis situation the selected position indicator light willflash and the original position indicator light will remain

ON. At this time, reduce speed and stop spinning thewheels to complete the shift. There may be a delay up to10 seconds for the shift to complete after the wheels havestopped spinning.

4HI to 4LO or 4LO to 4HI

NOTE: When shifting into or out of 4LO, some gearnoise may be heard. This noise is normal and is notdetrimental to the vehicle or occupants.

Shifting can be performed with the vehicle rolling 2-3mph (3-5 km/h) or completely stopped. USE EITHER OFTHE FOLLOWING PROCEDURES:

Preferred Procedure

1. With engine RUNNING, slow vehicle to 2-3 mph (3-5km/h).

2. Shift the transmission into NEUTRAL (depress clutchon manual transmissions).

STARTING AND OPERATING 211

5

Page 212: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

3. While still rolling, rotate the transfer case controlswitch to the desired position.

4. After the desired position indicator light is ON (notflashing), shift transmission back into gear (release clutchon manual transmissions).

Alternate Procedure

1. Bring the vehicle to complete stop.

2. With the key ON and the engine either OFF orRUNNING, shift the transmission into NEUTRAL (de-press clutch on manual transmissions).

3. Rotate the transfer case control switch to the desiredposition.

4. After the desired position indicator light is ON (notflashing), shift transmission back into gear (release clutchon manual transmissions).

NOTE: If steps 1 or 2 of either the Preferred or AlternateProcedure are not satisfied prior to attempting the shift orif they no longer are being met while the shift attempt isin process, then the indicator light will flash and thecurrent transfer case position will be maintained. To retrythe selection, turn the control knob back to the currentposition, wait five (5) seconds, and retry shift.

NOTE: The ignition key must be ON for a shift to takeplace and for the position indicator lights to be operable.If the key is not ON then the shift will not take place andno position indicator lights will be on or flashing.

NV244 Transfer Case Operating Information /PrecautionsThe NV244 is an electric shift transfer case and isoperated by the 4WD Control Switch, which is located onthe instrument panel.

212 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 213: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

The NV244 transfer case provides 4 mode positions -Normal all wheel drive high range, 4 wheel drive highrange, 4 wheel drive low range, and neutral.

This transfer case is equipped with an inter-axle differ-ential that allows driving the vehicle in the normal allwheel drive position (AWD) at all times on any givenroad surface, including dry hard surfaced roads. TheAWD mode allows the front and rear wheels to rotate atdifferent speeds. This eliminates driveline binding andcomponent wear normally associated with driving thevehicle in the 4HI position on dry hard surfaced roads.This feature provides the safety, security, and conve-nience of operating in all wheel drive at all timesregardless of road conditions.

When additional traction is required, the 4HI and 4LOpositions can be used to lock the front and rear drive-shafts together through the transfer case inter-axle differ-ential and force the front and rear wheels to rotate at the

same speed. This is accomplished by rotating the 4WDControl Switch to these positions. The 4HI and 4LOpositions are intended for loose or slippery road surfacesonly. Driving in the 4HI and 4LO positions on dry hardsurfaced roads may cause increased tire wear and dam-age to the driveline components.

The transfer case Neutral (N) position is selected bydepressing the recessed button located on the lower lefthand corner of the 4WD Control Switch.

NOTE: The transfer case Neutral (N) position is to beused for recreational towing only. (See Recreational Tow-ing section for specific procedures on shifting into andout of Neutral (N).

Transfer Case Position Indicator LightsTransfer case position indicator lights are located on theinstrument cluster. If there are no indicator lights on or

STARTING AND OPERATING 213

5

Page 214: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

flashing the transfer case position is all-wheel drive(AWD). If an indicator light is on, the desired position(4HI or 4LO) has been met.

If One or More Shift Requirements are not Met

1. An indicator light will flash until conditions are met.

2. The transfer case will not shift.

NOTE: Before retrying a selection, make certain that allthe necessary requirements for selecting a new transfercase position have been met. To retry the selection, turnthe control knob back to the current position, wait five (5)seconds, and retry selection. To find the shift require-ments, refer to the �Shifting Procedure� for your transfercase, located in this section of the owner’s manual.

The SERVICE 4WD warning light monitors the electricshift 4WD system. If this light remains on after engine

start up or illuminates during driving, it means that the4WD system is not functioning properly and that serviceis required.

WARNING!

Always engage the parking brake when poweringdown the vehicle if the �SVC 4WD� light is illumi-nated. Not engaging the parking brake may allowthe vehicle to roll, which may cause personal injury.

NOTE: Do not attempt to make a shift while only thefront or rear wheels are spinning. The NV244 transfercase is not equipped with a synchronizer and thereforethe front and rear driveshaft speeds must be equal for theshift to take place. Shifting while only the front or rearwheels are spinning can cause damage to the transfercase.

214 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 215: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

When operating your vehicle in 4LO, the engine speed isapproximately three times that of the AWD or 4HIpositions at a given road speed. Take care not to over-speed the engine and do not exceed 25 mph (40 km/h).

Proper operation of 4 wheel drive vehicles depends ontires of equal size, type and circumference on each wheel.Any difference in tire size can cause damage to thetransfer case.

Because 4 wheel drive provides improved traction, thereis a tendency to exceed safe turning and stopping speeds.Do not go faster than road conditions permit.

WARNING!

You or others could be injured if you leave thevehicle unattended with the transfer case in theNeutral (N) position without first fully engaging theparking brake. The transfer case Neutral (N) positiondisengages both the front and rear driveshafts fromthe powertrain and will allow the vehicle to moveregardless of the transmission position. The parkingbrake should always be applied when the driver isnot in the vehicle.

For additional information on the appropriate use of eachtransfer case mode position, see the information below:

AWDNormal All Wheel Drive High Range - Employs inter-axle differential. Allows front and rear wheels to rotate atdifferent speeds. All road surfaces.

STARTING AND OPERATING 215

5

Page 216: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

4HI4 Wheel Drive High Range - Locks the transfer caseinter-axle differential. Forces front and rear wheels torotate at the same speed. Additional traction for loose orslippery road surfaces only.

4LO4 Wheel Drive Low Range - Low speed 4 wheel drive.Locks the transfer case inter-axle differential. Forces thefront and rear wheels to rotate at the same speed.Additional traction and maximum pulling power forloose or slippery road surfaces only. Do not exceed 25mph (40 km/h).

NNeutral - Disengages both the front and rear driveshaftsfrom the powertrain. To be used for flat towing behindanother vehicle. See Recreational Towing for more infor-mation.

Shifting Procedure - NV244 Transfer Case

NOTE: If any of the requirements to select a new transfercase position have not been met, the transfer case will notshift.The indicator light for the previous position willremain ON and the newly selected position indicator lightwill continue to flash until all the requirements for theselected position have been met. To retry a shift: return the

216 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 217: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

control knob back to the original position, make certain allshift requirements have been met, wait five (5) seconds andtry the shift again.

AWD to 4HI or 4HI to AWDRotate the 4WD Control Switch to the desired position.Shifts between AWD and 4HI can be done with thevehicle stopped or in motion. With the vehicle in motion,the transfer case will engage / disengage faster if youmomentarily release the accelerator pedal after turningthe control switch. If the vehicle is stopped, the ignitionkey must be in the ON position with the engine eitherRUNNING or OFF. This shift cannot be completed if thekey is in the accessory position.

NOTE: On vehicles equipped with a Anti-Lock BrakeSystems, the 4x4 system will not allow shifts between

AWD/ 4HI if the rear wheels are spinning (no traction).In this situation, an indicator light will flash until condi-tions are met. At this time, reduce speed and stopspinning the wheels to complete the shift. There may bea delay up to 10 seconds for the shift to complete after thewheels have stopped spinning.

NOTE: Delayed shifting out of the 4HI position may beexperienced due to uneven tire wear, low tire pressure, orexcessive loading.

4HI to 4LO or 4LO to 4HI

NOTE: When shifting into or out of 4LO, some gearnoise may be heard. This noise is normal and is notdetrimental to the vehicle or occupants.

STARTING AND OPERATING 217

5

Page 218: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Shifting can be performed with the vehicle rolling 2-3mph (3-5 km/h) or completely stopped. USE EITHER OFTHE FOLLOWING PROCEDURES:

Preferred Procedure

1. With engine RUNNING, slow vehicle to 2-3 mph (3-5km/h).

2. Shift the transmission into NEUTRAL (depress clutchon manual transmissions).

3. Ensure ignition key is in the ON position with theengine either RUNNING or OFF. While still rolling,rotate the transfer case control switch to the desiredposition.

4. After the desired position indicator light is ON (notflashing), shift transmission back into gear (release clutchon manual transmissions).

Alternate Procedure

1. Bring the vehicle to complete stop.

2. With the key ON and the engine either OFF orRUNNING, shift the transmission into NEUTRAL (de-press clutch on manual transmissions).

3. Rotate the transfer case control switch to the desiredposition.

4. After the desired position indicator light is ON (notflashing), shift transmission back into gear (release clutchon manual transmissions).

NOTE: If steps 1 or 2 of either the Preferred or AlternateProcedure are not satisfied prior to attempting the shift orif they no longer are being met while the shift attempt isin process, then the desired position indicator light willflash continuously while the original position indicatorlight is ON, until all requirements have been met.

218 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 219: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: The ignition key must be ON for a shift to takeplace and for the position indicator lights to be operable.If the key is not ON, then the shift will not take place andno position indicator lights will be on or flashing.

LIMITED-SLIP REAR AXLE DIFFERENTIAL— IFEQUIPPEDThe limited-slip differential provides additional tractionon snow, ice, mud, sand and gravel. It improves tractionwhen there is a difference between the characteristics ofthe surface under the right and left rear wheels. Duringnormal driving and cornering, the limited-slip unit issimilar to a conventional differential. But on a slipperysurface, the differential delivers more of the driving effortto the wheel having the better traction.

WARNING!

On vehicles equipped with a limited-slip differen-tial, never run the engine with one rear wheel off theground. The vehicle may drive through the rearwheel remaining on the ground and cause you tolose control of the vehicle.

Care should be taken to avoid sudden accelerations whenboth rear wheels are on a slippery surface. This couldcause both rear wheels to spin, and allow the vehicle toslide sideways on the crowned surface of a road or in aturn.

STARTING AND OPERATING 219

5

Page 220: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

PARKING BRAKEThe foot operated parking brake is positioned below thelower left corner of the instrument panel. To release theparking brake, pull the parking brake release handle.

Be sure the parking brake is firmly set when parked andthe gear-shift lever is in the PARK position. Whenparking on a hill you should apply the parking brakebefore placing the gear shift lever in PARK; otherwise theload on the transmission locking mechanism may make itdifficult to move the selector out of PARK.

NOTE: The instrument cluster brake warning lightindicates only that the parking brake is applied. You mustbe sure the parking brake is fully applied before leavingthe vehicle.

When parking on a hill, turn the front wheels toward thecurb on a downhill grade and away from the curb on anuphill grade.

The parking brake should be applied whenever thedriver is not in the vehicle.

220 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 221: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

• Always fully apply the parking brake when leav-ing your vehicle, or the vehicle may roll and causedamage or injury. Also be certain to leave anautomatic transmission in Park. Failure to do somay cause the vehicle to roll and cause damage orinjury.

• Be sure the parking brake is fully disengagedbefore driving. Failure to do so can lead to brakefailure and an accident.

• Leaving children in a vehicle unattended is dan-gerous for a number of reasons. A child or otherscould be injured. Children should be warned notto touch the parking brake or the gear selectorlever. Don’t leave the key in the ignition. A childcould operate power windows, other controls, ormove the vehicle.

BRAKE SYSTEMIn the event power assist is lost for any reason (forexample, repeated brake applications with the engineoff), the brakes will still function. The effort required tobrake the vehicle will be significantly more than thatrequired with the power system operating.

If either the front or rear hydraulic system loses normalcapability, the remaining system will still function withsome loss of braking effectiveness. This will be evident byincreased pedal travel during application, greater pedalforce required to slow or stop, and activation of the BrakeWarning light and the ABS light during brake use.

STARTING AND OPERATING 221

5

Page 222: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Rear Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System — (IfEquipped)This Anti-Lock Brake System provides increased vehiclestability and brake performance under most brakingconditions. The system automatically controls the opera-tion of the rear brakes to prevent rear wheel lockup.

The system remains operational in the four-wheel drivemode. The level of performance is reduced when thefront brakes are locked up. This will cause the rear brakesto lock-up through the drivetrain, which may reduce theeffectiveness of the anti-lock system.

During severe braking conditions, particularly withchanging road surfaces, such as ice to concrete, a slightdrop or minor pulsation may be felt in the brake pedal.

WARNING!

Both Anti-Lock Brake Systems contain sophisticatedelectronic equipment. It may be susceptible to inter-ference caused by improperly installed or high out-put radio transmitting equipment. This interferencecan cause possible loss of anti-lock braking capabil-ity. Installation of such equipment should be doneby qualified professionals.

Four-Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System — IfEquippedThis Anti-Lock Brake System is designed to aid the driverin maintaining vehicle control under adverse brakingconditions. The system operates with a separate com-puter to modulate hydraulic pressure to prevent wheellock-up and help avoid skidding on slippery surfaces.

222 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 223: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

The system’s pump motor runs during an ABS stop toprovide regulated hydraulic pressure. The pump motormakes a low humming noise during operation, which isnormal.

The Anti-Lock Brake System includes an amber ABSwarning light. When the light is illuminated, the Anti-Lock Brake System is not functioning. The system revertsto standard non-anti-lock brakes. Turning the ignitionOFF and ON again may reset the Anti-Lock Brake Systemif the fault detected was only momentary.

WARNING!

Pumping of the Anti-Lock Brakes will diminishtheir effectiveness and may lead to an accident.Pumping makes the stopping distance longer. Justpress firmly on your brake pedal when you need toslow down or stop.

WARNING!

• Anti-lock Brake Systems (ABS) cannot preventthe natural laws of physics from acting on thevehicle, nor can it increase braking or steeringefficiency beyond that afforded by the conditionof the vehicle brakes and tires or the tractionafforded.

• The ABS cannot prevent accidents, includingthose resulting from excessive speed in turns,following another vehicle too closely, or hydro-planing. Only a safe, attentive, and skillful drivercan prevent accidents.

• The capabilities of an ABS equipped vehicle mustnever be exploited in a reckless or dangerousmanner which could jeopardize the user’s safetyor the safety of others.

STARTING AND OPERATING 223

5

Page 224: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

When you are in a severe braking condition involvinguse of the Anti-lock Brake System, you will experiencesome pedal drop as the vehicle comes to a stop. This isthe result of the system reverting to the base brakesystem.

Engagement of the Anti-lock Brake System may beaccompanied by a pulsing sensation. You may also hear aclicking noise. These occurrences are normal, and indi-cate that the system is functioning properly.

POWER STEERINGYour power steering system will provide mechanicalsteering capability if power assist is lost.

If for any reason the hydraulic pressure is interrupted, itwill still be possible to steer your vehicle. Under theseconditions you will experience an increase in steeringeffort and a noticeable amount of “free play” in thesteering wheel.

ROCKING THE VEHICLEIf vehicle becomes stuck in snow, sand, or mud, it canoften be moved by a rocking motion. Move the gearselector rhythmically between FIRST and REVERSE,while applying slight pressure to the accelerator.

The least amount of accelerator pedal pressure to main-tain the rocking motion without spinning the wheels orracing the engine is most effective. Allow the engine toidle with the transmission selector in NEUTRAL for atleast one minute after every five rocking-motion cycles.This will minimize overheating and reduce the risk oftransmission failure during prolonged efforts to free astuck vehicle.

224 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 225: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION

Tire Markings

NOTE:• P(Passenger)-Metric tire sizing is based on U.S. design

standards. P-Metric tires have the letter “P” moldedinto the sidewall preceding the size designation. Ex-ample: P215/65R15 95H.

• European Metric tire sizing is based on Europeandesign standards. Tires designed to this standard havethe tire size molded into the sidewall beginning withthe section width. The letter �P� is absent from this tiresize designation. Example: 215/65R15 96H

• LT(Light Truck)-Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.design standards. The size designation for LT-Metrictires is the same as for P-Metric tires except for theletters “LT” that are molded into the sidewall preced-ing the size designation. Example: LT235/85R16.

• Temporary Spare tires are high pressure compactspares designed for temporary emergency use only.Tires designed to this standard have the letter “T”molded into the sidewall preceding the size designa-tion. Example: T145/80D18 103M.

• High Flotation tire sizing is based on U.S. designstandards and begins with the tire diameter moldedinto the sidewall. Example: 31x10.5 R15 LT.

STARTING AND OPERATING 225

5

Page 226: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Tire Sizing Chart

EXAMPLE:Size Designation:

P = Passenger car tire size based on U.S. design standards�....blank....� = Passenger car tire based on European design standardsLT = Light Truck tire based on U.S. design standardsT = Temporary Spare tire31 = Overall Diameter in Inches (in)215 = Section Width in Milimeters (mm)65 = Aspect Ratio in Percent (%)

—Ratio of section height to section width of tire.10.5 = Section Width in Inches (in)R = Construction Code

—�R� means Radial Construction.—�D� means Diagonal or Bias Construction.

15 = Rim Diameter in Inches (in)

226 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 227: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

EXAMPLE:Service Description:

95 = Load Index—A numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can carry.

H = Speed Symbol—A symbol indicating the range of speeds at which a tire can carry a load correspondingto its load index under certain operating conditions.—The maximum speed corresponding to the Speed Symbol should only be achieved un-der specified operating conditions. (ie. tire pressure, vehicle loading, road conditions andposted speed limits).

Load Identification:�....blank....� = Absence of any text on sidewall of the tire indicates a Standard Load (SL) TireExtra Load (XL) = Extra Load (or Reinforced) TireLight Load = Light Load TireC,D,E = Load range associated with the maximum load a tire can carry at a specified pressure

Maximum Load — Maximum Load indicates the maximum load this tire is designed to carry.Maximum Pressure — Maximum Pressure indicates the maximum permissible cold tire inflation pressure for thistire.

STARTING AND OPERATING 227

5

Page 228: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Tire Identification Number (TIN)The TIN may be found on one or both sides of the tirehowever the date code may only be on one side. Tireswith white sidewalls will have the full TIN includingdate code located on the white sidewall side of the tire.

Look for the TIN on the outboard side of black sidewalltires as mounted on the vehicle. If the TIN is not found onthe outboard side then you will find it on the inboard sideof the tire.

EXAMPLE:DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301

DOT = Department of Transportation—This symbol certifies that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation tiresafety standards, and is approved for highway use.

MA = Code representing the tire manufacturing location.(2 digits)L9 = Code representing the tire size.(2 digits)ABCD = Code used by tire manufacturer.(1 to 4 digits)03 = Number representing the week in which the tire was manufactured.(2 digits)

—03 means the 3rd week.

228 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 229: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

EXAMPLE:01 = Number representing the year in which the tire was manufactured.(2 digits)

—01 means the year 2001.—Prior to July 2000, tire manufacturers were only required to have 1 number to represent the year inwhich the tire was manufactured. Example: 031 could represent the 3rd week of 1981 or 1991.

Tire Loading and Tire Pressure

Tire Placard Location

NOTE: The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listedon either the face of the driver’s door or the driver’s side“B” pillar.

Tire Placard Location

STARTING AND OPERATING 229

5

Page 230: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Tire and Loading Information Placard

This placard tells you important information about the:1) number of people that can be carried in the vehicle2) the total weight your vehicle can carry3) the tire size designed for your vehicle4) the cold tire inflation pressures for the front, rearand spare tires.

LoadingThe vehicle maximum load on the tire must not exceedthe load carrying capacity of the tire on your vehicle. Youwill not exceed the tire’s load carrying capacity if youadhere to the loading conditions, tire size and cold tireinflation pressures specified on the Tire and LoadingInformation placard and the Vehicle Loading section ofthis manual.

NOTE: Under a maximum loaded vehicle condition,gross axle weight ratings (GAWR’s) for the front and rearaxles must not be exceeded. For further information onGAWR’s, vehicle loading and trailer towing, see theVehicle Loading section of this manual.

To determine the maximum loading conditions of yourvehicle, locate the statement “The combined weight ofoccupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXXlbs.” on the Tire and Loading Information placard. The

Tire and Loading Information

230 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 231: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

combined weight of occupants, cargo/luggage andtrailer tongue weight (if applicable) should never exceedthe weight referenced here.

Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit

1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occu-pants and cargo should never exceed XXX pounds” onyour vehicle’s placard.

2. Determine the combined weight of the driver andpassengers that will be riding in your vehicle.

3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and pas-sengers from XXX kilograms or XXX pounds.

4. The resulting figure equals the available amount ofcargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if “XXX”amount equals 1400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb.passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargoand luggage load capacity is 650 lb. (since 5 x 150 = 750,and 1400 – 750 = 650 lb.)

5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargobeing loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safelyexceed the available cargo and luggage load capacitycalculated in step 4.

6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from yourtrailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult thismanual to determine how this reduces the availablecargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.

NOTE: The following table shows examples on how tocalculate total load, cargo/luggage and towing capacitiesof your vehicle with varying seating configurations andnumber and size of occupants. This table is for illustra-tion purposes only and may not be accurate for theseating and load carry capacity of your vehicle.

NOTE: For the following example the combined weightof occupants and cargo should never exceed 865 lbs. (392Kg).

STARTING AND OPERATING 231

5

Page 232: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

232 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 233: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Overloading of your tires is dangerous. Overloadingcan cause tire failure, affect vehicle handling, andincrease your stopping distance. Use tires of therecommended load capacity for your vehicle. Neveroverload them.

TIRES—GENERAL INFORMATION

Tire PressureProper tire inflation pressure is essential to the safe andsatisfactory operation of your vehicle. Three primaryareas are affected by improper tire pressure:

1. Safety—

WARNING!

Improperly inflated tires are dangerous and can causeaccidents.• Under inflation increases tire flexing and can result intire failure.• Over inflation reduces a tire’s ability to cushionshock. Objects on the road and chuck holes can causedamage that results in tire failure.• Unequal tire pressures can cause steering problems.You could lose control of your vehicle.• Over inflated or under inflated tires can affect vehiclehandling and can fail suddenly, resulting in loss ofvehicle control.• Unequal tire pressures from one side of the vehicle tothe other can cause the vehicle to drift to the right or left.Always drive with each tire inflated to the recom-mended cold tire inflation pressure.

STARTING AND OPERATING 233

5

Page 234: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

2. Economy—Improper inflation pressures can cause uneven wearpatterns to develop across the tire tread. These abnormalwear patterns will reduce tread life resulting in a need forearlier tire replacement. Underinflation also increases tirerolling resistance and results in higher fuel consumption.

3. Ride Comfort and Vehicle Stability—Proper tire inflation contributes to a comfortable ride.Overinflation produces a jarring and uncomfortable ride.

Tire Inflation PressuresThe proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on eitherthe face of the driver’s door or the driver’s side “B” pillar.

Some vehicles may have Supplemental Tire PressureInformation for vehicle loads that are less than themaximum loaded vehicle condition. These pressure con-ditions will be found in the “Supplemental Tire PressureInformation” section of this manual.

The pressure should be checked and adjusted as well asinspecting for signs of tire wear or visible damage at leastonce a month. Use a good quality pocket-type gauge tocheck tire pressure. Do not make a visual judgementwhen determining proper inflation. Radial tires may lookproperly inflated even when they are under inflated.

Tire Placard Location

234 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 235: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

CAUTION!

After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure, al-ways reinstall the valve stem cap–if equipped. Thiswill prevent moisture and dirt from entering thevalve stem, which could damage the valve stem.

Inflation pressures specified on the placard are always“cold tire inflation pressure”. Cold tire inflation pressureis defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has notbeen driven for at least 3 hours, or driven less than 1mile(1 km) after a 3 hour period. The cold tire inflationpressure must not exceed the maximum inflation pres-sure molded into the tire side wall.

Check tire pressures more often if subject to a wide rangeof outdoor temperatures, as tire pressures vary withtemperature changes.

Tire pressures change by approximately 1 psi (7 kPa) per12° F (7° C) of air temperature change. Keep this in mindwhen checking tire pressure inside a garage, especially inthe winter.

Example: If garage temperature = 68° F (20° C) and theoutside temperature = 32° F (0° C) then the cold tireinflation pressure should be increased by 3 psi (21 kPa),which equals 1 psi (7 kPa) for every 12° F (7° C) for thisoutside temperature condition.

Tire pressure may increase from 2 to 6 psi (13 to 40 kPa)during operation. DO NOT reduce this normal pressurebuild up or your tire pressure will be too low.

Tire Pressures for High Speed OperationThe manufacturer advocates driving at safe speedswithin posted speed limits. Where speed limits or condi-tions are such that the vehicle can be driven at highspeeds, maintaining correct tire inflation pressure is veryimportant. Increased tire pressure and reduced vehicle

STARTING AND OPERATING 235

5

Page 236: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

loading may be required for high speed vehicle opera-tion. Refer to original equipment or an authorized tiredealer for recommended safe operating speeds, loadingand cold tire inflation pressures.

WARNING!

High speed driving with your vehicle under maxi-mum load is dangerous. The added strain on yourtires could cause them to fail. You could have aserious accident. Don’t drive a vehicle loaded to themaximum capacity at continuous speeds above 75mph (120 km/h).

Radial-Ply Tires

WARNING!

Combining radial ply tires with other types of tireson your vehicle will cause your vehicle to handlepoorly. The instability could cause an accident. Al-ways use radial ply tires in sets of four (or 6, in caseof trucks with dual rear wheels). Never combinethem with other types of tires.

Cuts and punctures in radial tires are repairable only inthe tread area because of sidewall flexing. Consult yourauthorized tire dealer for radial tire repairs.

236 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 237: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Compact Spare Tire — If EquippedThe compact spare is for temporary emergency use withradial tires. It is engineered to be used on your stylevehicle only. Since this tire has limited tread life, theoriginal tire should be repaired (or replaced) and rein-stalled at the first opportunity.

WARNING!

Temporary use spare tires are for emergency useonly. With these tires, do not drive more than 50 mph(80 km/h). Temporary-use spare tires have limitedtread life. When the tread is worn to the tread wearindicators, the temporary use spare tire needs to bereplaced. Be sure to follow the warnings whichapply to your spare. Failure to do so could result inspare tire failure and loss of vehicle control.

Do not install a wheel cover or attempt to mount aconventional tire on the compact spare wheel, since thewheel is designed specifically for the compact spare.

Do not install more than one compact spare tire/wheelon the vehicle at any given time.

CAUTION!

Because of the reduced ground clearance, do not takeyour vehicle through an automatic car wash with thecompact spare installed. Damage to the vehicle mayresult.

STARTING AND OPERATING 237

5

Page 238: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Limited Use Spare — If EquippedThe limited use spare tire is for temporary emergency useon your vehicle. This tire is identified by a limited usespare tire warning label located on the limited use sparetire and wheel assembly. This tire may look like theoriginal equipped tire on the front or rear axle of yourvehicle, but it is not. Installation of this limited use sparetire affects vehicle handling. Since it is not the same tire,replace (or repair) the original tire and reinstall on thevehicle at the first opportunity.

WARNING!

The limited use spare tires are for emergency useonly. Installation of this limited use spare tire affectsvehicle handling. With this tire, do not drive morethan 60 mph (100 km/h). Keep inflated to the coldtire inflation pressure listed on either your tireplacard or limited use spare tire and wheel assembly.Replace (or repair) the original tire at the firstopportunity and reinstall it on your vehicle. Failureto do so could result in loss of vehicle control.

Tire SpinningWhen stuck in mud, sand, snow, or ice conditions, do notspin your vehicle’s wheels above 35 mph (55 km/h).

See the paragraph on Freeing A Stuck Vehicle in Section6 of this manual.

238 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 239: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces gener-ated by excessive wheel speeds may cause tire dam-age or failure. A tire could explode and injuresomeone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels fasterthan 35 mph (55 km/h) when you are stuck. Anddon’t let anyone near a spinning wheel, no matterwhat the speed.

Tread Wear IndicatorsTread wear indicators are in the original equipment tiresto help you in determining when your tires should bereplaced.

These indicators are molded into the bottom of the treadgrooves and will appear as bands when the tread depthbecomes 1/16 inch (2 mm). When the tread is worn to thetread wear indicators, the tire should be replaced.

Many states have laws requiring tire replacement at thispoint.

STARTING AND OPERATING 239

5

Page 240: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Life of TireThe service life of a tire is dependent upon varyingfactors including but not limited to:

• Driving style

• Tire pressure

• Distance driven

WARNING!

Tires and spare tire should be replaced after sixyears, regardless of the remaining tread. Failure tofollow this warning can result in sudden tire failure.You could lose control and have an accident result-ing in serious injury or death.

Keep unmounted tires in a cool, dry place with as littleexposure to light as possible. Protect tires from contactwith oil, grease and gasoline.

Replacement TiresThe tires on your new vehicle provide a balance of manycharacteristics. They should be inspected regularly forwear and correct cold tire inflation pressure. The manu-facturer strongly recommends that you use tires equiva-lent to the originals in size, quality and performancewhen replacement is needed (see the paragraph on treadwear indicators). Refer to the Tire and Loading Informa-tion placard for the size designation of your tire. Theservice description and load identification will be foundon the original equipment tire. Failure to use equivalentreplacement tires may adversely affect the safety, han-dling, and ride of your vehicle. We recommend that youcontact your original equipment or an authorized tiredealer with any questions you may have on tire specifi-cations or capability.

240 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 241: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

• Do not use a tire, wheel size or rating other than thatspecified for your vehicle. Some combinations ofunapproved tires and wheels may change suspensiondimensions and performance characteristics, result-ing in changes to steering, handling, and braking ofyour vehicle. This can cause unpredictable handlingand stress to steering and suspension components.You could lose control and have an accident resultingin serious injury or death. Use only the tire and wheelsizes with load ratings approved for your vehicle.

• Never use a tire with a smaller load index or capacity,other than what was originally equipped on yourvehicle. Using a tire with a smaller load index couldresult in tire overloading and failure. You could losecontrol and have an accident.

• Failure to equip your vehicle with tires havingadequate speed capability can result in sudden tirefailure and loss of vehicle control.

CAUTION!

Replacing original tires with tires of a different sizemay result in false speedometer and odometer read-ings.

Alignment And BalancePoor suspension alignment may result in:

• Fast tire wear.

• Uneven tire wear, such as feathering and one-sidedwear.

• Vehicle pull to right or left.

Tires may also cause the vehicle to pull to the left or right.Alignment will not correct this condition. See your dealerfor proper diagnosis.

STARTING AND OPERATING 241

5

Page 242: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Improper alignment will not cause vehicle vibration.Vibration may be a result of tire and wheel out-of-balance. Proper balancing will reduce vibration andavoid tire cupping and spotty wear.

SUPPLEMENTAL TIRE PRESSURE INFORMATIONA light load vehicle condition is defined as two passen-gers {150 lbs (68 kg) each} plus 200 lbs (91kg) of cargo.Cold tire inflation pressures for a lightly loaded vehiclewill be found on the face of the driver’s door.

TIRE CHAINSUse “Class S” chains only on the rear tires on Dakotatrucks, or other traction aids that meet SAE Type “S”specifications.

NOTE: Chains must be the proper size for the vehicle,as recommended by the chain manufacturer.

CAUTION!

To avoid damage to your vehicle, tires or chains, observe thefollowing precautions:• Because of limited chain clearance between tires and other

suspension components, it is important that only chains ingood condition are used. Broken chains can cause seriousvehicle damage. Stop the vehicle immediately if noiseoccurs that could suggest chain breakage. Remove thedamaged parts of the chain before further use.

• Install chains as tightly as possible and then retighten afterdriving about 1/2 mile (0.8 km).

• Do not exceed 45 mph (72 km/h).• Drive cautiously and avoid severe turns and large bumps,

especially with a loaded vehicle.• Do not install tire chains on front wheels of 4x2 vehicles.• Do not drive for a prolonged period on dry pavement.• Observe the tire chain manufacturer’s instructions on

method of installation, operating speed, and conditions forusage. Always use the lower suggested operating speed ofthe chain manufacturer if different than the speed recom-mended by the manufacturer.

242 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 243: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

These cautions apply to all chain traction devices, includ-ing link and cable (radial) chains.

Tire chain use is permitted only on the rear tires ofDakota trucks.

NOTE: The use of class “S” chains is permitted onDakotas with P245/70R16 tires.

CAUTION!

Do not use tire chains on 4x4 Dakota trucksequipped with P265/65R17 tires. There may not beadequate clearance for the chains and you are riskingstructural or body damage to your vehicle. Do notuse tire chains on the 4X2 front wheels of Dakotamodels. There may not be adequate clearance for thechains and you are risking structural or body dam-age to your vehicle.

SNOW TIRESSnow tires should be of the same size and type construc-tion as the front tires. Consult the manufacturer of thesnow tire to determine any maximum vehicle speedrequirement associated with the tire. These tires shouldalways be operated at the vehicle maximum capacityinflation pressures under any load condition.

While studded tires improve performance on ice, skidand traction capability on wet or dry surfaces may bepoorer than that of non-studded tires. Some states pro-hibit studded tires; therefore, local laws should bechecked before using these tire types.

STARTING AND OPERATING 243

5

Page 244: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONSTires on the front and rear axles of vehicles operate atdifferent loads and perform different steering, driving,and braking functions. For these reasons, they wear atunequal rates and tend to develop irregular wear pat-terns. These effects can be reduced by timely rotation oftires. The benefits of rotation are especially worthwhilewith aggressive tread designs such as those on all seasontype tires. Rotation will increase tread life, help to main-tain mud, snow and wet traction levels, and contribute toa smooth, quiet ride.

Follow the recommended tire rotation frequency for yourtype of driving found in the “Maintenance Schedules”Section of this manual. More frequent rotation is permis-sible if desired. The reasons for any rapid or unusualwear should be corrected prior to rotation being per-formed.

244 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 245: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

FUEL REQUIREMENTSAll engines are designed to meet all emis-sions regulations and provide excellentfuel economy and performance when us-ing high quality unleaded “regular” gaso-line having an octane rating of 87. Theroutine use of premium gasoline is notrecommended. Under normal conditions

the use of premium fuel will not provide a benefit overhigh quality regular gasolines and in some circumstancesmay result in poorer performance.

The 4.7 HO engine is designed to meet allemissions regulations and provide satisfac-tory fuel economy and performance whenusing high quality unleaded gasoline hav-ing an octane range of 87 to 91. The manu-facturer recommends the use of 91 octanefor optimum performance.

Light spark knock at low engine speeds is not harmful toyour engine. However, continued heavy spark knock athigh speeds can cause damage and immediate service isrequired.

Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such as hardstarting, stalling and hesitations. If you experience thesesymptoms, try another brand of “regular” gasoline be-fore considering service for the vehicle.

Over 40 auto manufacturers world-wide have issued andendorsed consistent gasoline specifications (the World-wide Fuel Charter, WWFC) to define fuel propertiesnecessary to deliver enhanced emissions, performanceand durability for your vehicle. We recommend the useof gasolines that meet the WWFC specifications if theyare available.

3.7L/4.7LEngines

4.7L HOEngines

STARTING AND OPERATING 245

5

Page 246: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Reformulated GasolineMany areas of the country require the use of cleanerburning gasoline referred to as “Reformulated Gasoline.”Reformulated gasolines contain oxygenates, and are spe-cifically blended to reduce vehicle emissions and im-prove air quality.

We strongly support the use of reformulated gasolines.Properly blended reformulated gasolines will provideexcellent performance and durability for the engine andfuel system components.

Gasoline/Oxygenate BlendsSome fuel suppliers blend unleaded gasoline with oxy-genates such as 10% ethanol, MTBE and ETBE. Oxygen-ates are required in some areas of the country during thewinter months to reduce carbon monoxide emissions.Fuels blended with these oxygenates may be used inyour vehicle.

CAUTION!

DO NOT use gasolines containing METHANOL.Gasoline containing methanol may damage criticalfuel system components.

MMT In GasolineMMT is a manganese-containing metallic additive that isblended into some gasoline to increase octane. Gasolinesblended with MMT provide no performance advantagebeyond gasolines of the same octane number withoutMMT. Gasolines blended with MMT reduce spark pluglife and reduce emission system performance. We recom-mend that gasolines free of MMT be used in your vehicle.The MMT content of gasoline may not be indicated onthe gasoline pump; therefore, you should ask your gaso-line retailer whether or not his/her gasoline containsMMT.

246 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 247: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

It is even more important to look for gasolines withoutMMT in Canada because MMT can be used at levelshigher than allowed in the United States. MMT is pro-hibited in Federal and California reformulated gasolines.

Materials Added To FuelAll gasolines sold in the United States are required tocontain effective detergent additives. Use of additionaldetergents or other additives is not needed under normalconditions and would result in unnecessary cost. There-fore, you should not have to add anything to the fuel.

ADDING FUEL

NOTE: If fuel is poured from a portable container, thecontainer should have a flexible nozzle long enough toextend into the fuel filler tube.

Fuel Cap Holder

STARTING AND OPERATING 247

5

Page 248: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

CAUTION!

To avoid fuel spillage and overfilling, do not “topoff” the fuel tank after filling.

NOTE: When the fuel nozzle “clicks” or shuts off, thefuel tank is full.

NOTE: Tighten the gas cap until you hear a “clicking”sound. This is an indication that the gas cap is properlytightened. Make sure that the gas cap is tightened eachtime the vehicle is refueled.

WARNING!

A fire may result if gasoline is pumped into aportable container that is inside of a vehicle or on atruck bed. You could be burned. Always place gascontainers on the ground while filling.

Fuel Filler Cap (Gas Cap)The gas cap is behind the fuel filler door. If the gas cap islost or damaged, be sure the replacement cap is for usewith this vehicle.

CAUTION!

Damage to the fuel system or emission controlsystem could result from using an improper fueltank filler tube cap (gas cap). A poorly fitting capcould let impurities into the fuel system.

248 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 249: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

• Never allow any lit smoking materials near thevehicles while removing the cap or filling thetank.

• Never add fuel to the vehicle when the engine isrunning.

Fuel System Cautions

CAUTION!

Follow these guidelines to maintain your vehicle’sperformance:

• The use of leaded gas is prohibited by Federal law.Using leaded gasoline can impair engine performance,damage the emission control system.

• An out-of-tune engine, or certain fuel or ignitionmalfunctions, can cause the catalytic converter tooverheat. If you notice a pungent burning odor orsome light smoke, your engine may be out of tune ormalfunctioning and may require immediate service.Contact your dealer for service assistance.

• When pulling a heavy load or driving a fully loadedvehicle when the humidity is low and the temperatureis high, use a premium unleaded fuel to help preventspark knock. If spark knock persists, lighten the load,or engine piston damage may result.

• The use of fuel additives which are now being sold asoctane enhancers is not recommended. Many of theseproducts contain high concentrations of methanol.Fuel system damage or vehicle performance problemsresulting from the use of such fuels or additives is notthe responsibility of the manufacturer.

STARTING AND OPERATING 249

5

Page 250: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions controlsystems can result in civil penalties being assessedagainst you.

Carbon Monoxide Warnings

WARNING!

Carbon monoxide (CO) in exhaust gases is deadly.Follow the precautions below to prevent carbonmonoxide poisoning:

• Do not inhale exhaust gases. They contain carbonmonoxide, a colorless and odorless gas which can kill.Never run the engine in a closed area, such as agarage, and never sit in a parked vehicle with theengine running for an extended period. If the vehicle isstopped in an open area with the engine running for

more than a short period, adjust the ventilation systemto force fresh, outside air into the vehicle.

• Guard against carbon monoxide with proper mainte-nance. Have the exhaust system inspected every timethe vehicle is raised. Have any abnormal conditionsrepaired promptly. Until repaired, drive with all sidewindows fully open.

• Keep the liftgate closed when driving your vehicle toprevent carbon monoxide and other poisonous ex-haust gases from entering the vehicle.

CATALYTIC CONVERTERThe catalytic converter requires the use of unleaded fuelonly. Leaded gasoline will destroy the effectiveness of thecatalyst as an emission control device. Under normaloperating conditions, the catalytic converter will notrequire maintenance. However, you must keep the en-gine maintained to assure proper operation and preventpossible damage.

250 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 251: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions controlsystems can result in civil penalties being assessedagainst you.

CAUTION!

Damage to the catalytic converter can result if yourvehicle is not kept in proper operating condition. Inthe event of engine malfunction, particularly involv-ing engine misfire or other apparent loss of perfor-mance, have your vehicle serviced promptly. Contin-ued operation of your vehicle with a severemalfunction could cause the converter to overheat,resulting in possible damage to the converter andvehicle.

As with any vehicle, do not park or operate this vehicle inareas where combustible materials such as grass or leavescan come in contact with a hot exhaust system.

A scorching odor may be detected if you continue to runa malfunctioning engine. The odor may indicate severeand abnormal catalyst overheating. If this occurs, thevehicle should be stopped, the engine shut off and thevehicle allowed to cool. Service, including a tune-up tomanufacturer’s specifications should be obtained imme-diately.

To minimize the possibility of catalyst damage:

• Do not shut off the engine or interrupt the ignitionwhen the transmission is in gear and the vehicle is inmotion.

• Do not try to start engine by pushing or towing thevehicle.

• Do not idle the engine with any spark plug wiresdisconnected or removed, such as when diagnostictesting, or for prolonged periods during very roughidling or malfunctioning operating conditions.

STARTING AND OPERATING 251

5

Page 252: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

VEHICLE LOADING

Certification LabelAs required by National Highway Traffic Safety Admin-istration Regulations, your vehicle has a certificationlabel affixed to the driver’s side door.

This label contains the month and year of manufacture,Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR), Gross Axle Weight

Rating (GAWR) front and rear, and Vehicle IdentificationNumber (VIN). A Month-Day-Hour (MDH) number isincluded on this label and shows the Month, Day, andHour of manufacture. The bar code that appears on thebottom of the label is your Vehicle Identification Number(VIN).

Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)The GVWR is the total permissible weight of your vehicleincluding driver, passengers, vehicle, options, and cargo.The label also specifies maximum capacities of front andrear axle systems. Total load must be limited so thatGVWR is not exceeded.

PayloadThe payload of a vehicle is defined as the allowable loadweight a truck can carry including the weight of thedriver, all passengers, options, and cargo.

252 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 253: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)The GAWR is the maximum permissible load on the frontand rear axles. The load must be distributed in the cargoarea so that the GAWR of each axle is not exceeded.

Each axle GAWR is determined by the component in thesystem with the lowest load carrying capacity (axle,springs, tires, or wheels).

Heavier axles or suspension components sometimesspecified by purchasers for increased durability do notnecessarily increase the vehicle’s GVWR.

Tire SizeThis is the minimum allowable tire size for your vehicle.Replacement tires must be equal to the load capacity ofthis tire size.

Rim SizeThis is the rim size that is appropriate for the tire sizelisted.

Inflation Pressure (Cold)This is the cold tire inflation pressure for your vehicle forall loading conditions up to full GAWR.

Curb WeightThe curb weight of a vehicle is defined as the total weightof the vehicle with all fluids, including vehicle fuel, at fullcapacity conditions, and with no occupants or cargoloaded into the vehicle. The front and rear curb weightvalues are determined by weighing your vehicle on acommercial scale before any occupants or cargo areadded.

LoadingThe actual total weight and the weight of the front andrear of your vehicle at the ground can best be determinedby weighing it when it is loaded and ready for operation.

STARTING AND OPERATING 253

5

Page 254: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

The entire vehicle should first be weighed on a commer-cial scale to insure that the GVWR has not been exceeded.The weight on the front and rear of the vehicle shouldthen be determined separately to be sure that the load isproperly distributed over front and rear axle. Weighingthe vehicle may show that the GAWR of either the frontor rear axles has been exceeded but the total load iswithin the specified GVWR. If so, weight must be shiftedfrom front to rear or rear to front as appropriate until thespecified weight limitations are met.

Store heavier items down low and be sure that the weightis distributed equally. Stow all loose items securely beforedriving.

Improper weight distribution can have an adverse effecton the way your vehicle steers and handles and the waythe brakes operate.

WARNING!

Do not load your vehicle any heavier than theGVWR or the maximum front and rear GAWR. Ifyou do, parts on your vehicle can break, or it canchange the way your vehicle handles. This couldcause you to lose control. Also, overloading canshorten the life of your vehicle.

A loaded vehicle is shown in the following example. Notethat neither GVWR nor GAWR capabilities are exceeded.Overloading can cause potential safety hazards andshorten service life.

254 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 255: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: The weights shown in this chart are not theweights for your vehicle. Also, the amount of load addedto both the front and rear axles can be computed after thevehicle has been weighed both in its �curb weight� condi-tion, and in its �loaded and ready for operation� condition.

Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) 6500 LBS.

TRAILER TOWINGIn this section you will find safety tips and informationon limits to the type of towing you can reasonably dowith your vehicle. Before towing a trailer carefully re-view this information to tow your load as efficiently andsafely as possible.

To maintain warranty coverage, follow the requirementsand recommendations in this manual concerning ve-hicles used for trailer towing.

Common Towing DefinitionsThe following trailer towing related definitions will assistyou in understanding the following information:

Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)The GVWR is the total allowable weight of your vehicle.This includes driver, passengers, cargo and tongueweight. The total load must be limited so that you do notexceed the GVWR.

STARTING AND OPERATING 255

5

Page 256: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Gross Trailer Weight (GTW)The gross trailer weight (GTW) is the weight of the trailerplus the weight of all cargo, consumables and equipment(permanent or temporary) loaded in or on the trailer in its�loaded and ready for operation� condition. The recom-mended way to measure GTW is to put your fully loadedtrailer on a vehicle scale. The entire weight of the trailermust be supported by the scale.

Gross Combination Weight Rating (GCWR)The gross combination weight rating (GCWR) is the totalpermissible weight of your vehicle and trailer whenweighed in combination. (Note that GCWR ratings in-clude a 68 kg (150 lbs) allowance for the presence of adriver).

Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)The GAWR is the maximum capacity of the front and rearaxles. Distribute the load over the front and rear axlesevenly. Make sure that you do not exceed either front orrear GAWR.

WARNING!

It is important that you do not exceed the maximumfront or rear GAWR. A dangerous driving conditioncan result if either rating is exceeded. You could losecontrol of the vehicle and have an accident.

Tongue Weight (TW)The downward force exerted on the hitch ball by thetrailer. In most cases it should not be less than 10% ormore than 15% of the trailer load. You must consider thisas part of the load on your vehicle.

256 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 257: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Frontal AreaThe maximum height and maximum width of the front ofa trailer.

Trailer Sway ControlThe trailer sway control is a telescoping link that can beinstalled between the hitch receiver and the trailer tonguethat typically provides adjustable friction associated withthe telescoping motion to dampen any unwanted trailerswaying motions while traveling.

Weight-Carrying HitchA weight-carrying hitch supports the trailer tongueweight, just as if it were luggage located at a hitch ball orsome other connecting point of the truck. These kind ofhitches are the most popular on the market today andthey’re commonly used to tow small- and medium-sizedtrailers.

Weight-Distributing HitchA weight-distributing hitch includes a receiver attachedto the tow vehicle, plus a removable hitch head andspring bar assembly that fits into the receiver openingand hook up brackets that connect the spring bars to thetrailer frame.

Fifth-Wheel HitchA special high platform with a coupling that mounts overthe rear axle of the tow vehicle in the truck bed. Connectsa vehicle and fifth-wheel trailer with a coupling king pin.

Gooseneck HitchThe gooseneck hitch employs a pivoted coupling armwhich attaches to a ball mounted in the bed of a pickuptruck. The coupling arm connects to the hitch mountedover the rear axle in the truck bed.

STARTING AND OPERATING 257

5

Page 258: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Trailer Hitch ClassificationThe rear bumper is intended to tow trailers up to 2,000lbs (907 kg) without added equipment or alterations tothe standard equipment. Your vehicle may be factoryequipped for safe towing of trailers weighing over 2,000lbs (907 kg) with the optional Trailer Tow Prep Package.See your dealer for package content.

The following chart provides the industry standard forthe maximum trailer weight a given trailer hitch class cantow and should be used to assist you in selecting thecorrect trailer hitch for your intended towing condition.Refer to “Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum TrailerWeight Ratings)” for the website address that containsthe necessary information for your specific drivetrain.

Trailer Hitch ClassificationClass Max. GTW

(Gross Trailer Wt.)Class I - Light Duty 2,000 lbs (907 kg)Class II - Medium Duty 3,500 lbs (1587 kg)Class III - Heavy Duty 5,000 lbs (2268 kg)Class IV - Extra HeavyDuty

10,000 lbs (4540 kg)

Fifth Wheel/Gooseneck Greater than 10,000 lbs(4540 kg)

All trailer hitches should be professionally installed onyour vehicle.

258 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 259: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Trailer Towing Weights (Maximum Trailer WeightRatings)

NOTE: For additional trailer towing information (maxi-mum trailer weight ratings) refer to the following websiteaddresses:

• http:// www.dodge.com/towing.

• http:// www.dodge.ca (Canada).

Trailer and Tongue WeightAlways load a trailer with 60% to 65% of the weight inthe front of the trailer. This places 10% to 15% of theGross Trailer Weight (GTW) on the tow hitch of yourvehicle. Loads balanced over the wheels or heavier in therear can cause the trailer to sway severely side to sidewhich will cause loss of control of vehicle and trailer.Failure to load trailers heavier in front is the cause ofmany trailer accidents.

Never exceed the maximum tongue weight stamped onyour bumper or trailer hitch.

Consider the following items when computing theweight on the rear axle of the vehicle:

• The tongue weight of the trailer.

STARTING AND OPERATING 259

5

Page 260: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• The weight of any other type of cargo or equipmentput in or on your vehicle.

• The weight of the driver and all passengers.

NOTE: Remember that everything put into or on thetrailer adds to the load on your vehicle. Also, additionalfactory-installed options, or dealer-installed options,must be considered as part of the total load on yourvehicle. Refer to the Tire and Loading Information plac-ard in the Tire Safety Information Section of this manual.

Trailer sway control and a weight distributing (loadequalizing) hitch are recommended for Tongue Weights(TW) above 150 lbs (68 kg) and required for TongueWeights above 300 lbs (136 kg).

Towing RequirementsTo promote proper break-in of your new vehicle driv-etrain components the following guidelines are recom-mended:

CAUTION!

• Avoid towing a trailer for the first 500 miles (805km) of vehicle operation. Doing so may damageyour vehicle.

• During the first 500 miles (805 km) of trailertowing, limit your speed to 50 mph (80 km/h).

Perform the maintenance listed in Section 8 of thismanual. When towing a trailer, never exceed the GAWR,or GCWR, ratings.

260 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 261: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Improper towing can lead to an injury accident.Follow these guidelines to make your trailer towingas safe as possible:

Make certain that the load is secured in the trailerand will not shift during travel. When traileringcargo that is not fully secured, dynamic load shiftscan occur that may be difficult for the driver tocontrol. You could lose control of your vehicle andhave an accident.

• When hauling cargo or towing a trailer, do not over-load your vehicle or trailer. Overloading can cause aloss of control, poor performance or damage to brakes,axle, engine, transmission, steering, suspension, chas-sis structure or tires.

• Safety chains must always be used between yourvehicle and trailer. Always connect the chains to theframe or hook retainers of the vehicle hitch. Cross thechains under the trailer tongue and allow enoughslack for turning corners.

• Vehicles with trailers should not be parked on a grade.When parking, apply the parking brake on the towvehicle. Put the tow vehicle automatic transmission inP for Park. With a manual transmission, shift thetransmission into reverse. And with four-wheel-drivevehicles, make sure the transfer case is not in neutral.Always, block or �chock� the trailer wheels.

• GCWR must not be exceeded.

• Total weight must be distributed between the towvehicle and the trailer such that the following fourratings are not exceeded:

1. GVWR

STARTING AND OPERATING 261

5

Page 262: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

2. GTW

3. GAWR

4. Tongue weight rating for the trailer hitch utilized(This requirement may limit the ability to alwaysachieve the 10% to 15% range of tongue weight as apercentage of total trailer weight).

Towing Requirements — Tires

− Do not attempt to tow a trailer while using a compactspare tire.

− Proper tire inflation pressures are essential to the safeand satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Refer to theTires–General Information section of this manual onTire Pressures for proper tire inflation procedures.

− Also, check the trailer tires for proper tire inflationpressures before trailer usage.

− Check for signs of tire wear or visible tire damagebefore towing a trailer. Refer to the Tires–GeneralInformation section of this manual on Tread WearIndicators for the proper inspection procedure.

− When replacing tires refer to the Tires–General Infor-mation section of this manual on Replacement Tires forproper tire replacement procedures. Replacing tireswith a higher load carrying capacity will not increasethe vehicle’s GVWR and GAWR limits.

Towing Requirements — Trailer Brakes

− Do not interconnect the hydraulic brake system orvacuum system of your vehicle with that of the trailer.This could cause inadequate braking and possiblepersonal injury.

262 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 263: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

− An electronically actuated trailer brake controller isrequired when towing a trailer with electronicallyactuated brakes. When towing a trailer equipped witha hydraulic surge actuated brake system, an electronicbrake controller is not required.

− Trailer brakes are recommended for trailers over 1,000lbs (454 kg) and required for trailers in excess of 2,000lbs (907 kg).

CAUTION!

If the trailer weighs more than 1,000 lbs (454 kg)loaded, it should have its own brakes and theyshould be of adequate capacity. Failure to do thiscould lead to accelerated brake lining wear, higherbrake pedal effort, and longer stopping distances.

WARNING!

Do not connect trailer brakes to your vehicle’s hy-draulic brake lines. It can overload your brake sys-tem and cause it to fail. You might not have brakeswhen you need them and could have an accident.

Towing any trailer will increase your stopping dis-tance. When towing you should allow for additionalspace between your vehicle and the vehicle in frontof you. Failure to do so could result in an accident.

Towing Requirements — Trailer Lights & WiringWhenever you pull a trailer, regardless of the trailer size,stop lights and turn signals on the trailer are required formotoring safety.

The Trailer Tow Package may include a 4 and 7 pinwiring harness. Use a factory approved trailer harnessand connector.

STARTING AND OPERATING 263

5

Page 264: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: Do not cut or splice wiring into the vehicleswiring harness.

The electrical connections are all complete to the vehiclebut you must mate the harness to a trailer connector.Refer to the following illustrations.

Towing TipsBefore setting out on a trip, practice turning, stoppingand backing the trailer in an area away from heavytraffic.

4 - Pin Connector

7- Pin Connector

264 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 265: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

If using a manual transmission vehicle for trailer towing,all starts must be in FIRST gear to avoid excessive clutchslippage.

Towing Tips — Automatic TransmissionThe “D” range can be selected when towing. However, iffrequent shifting occurs while in this range, the “TOWHAUL” or “OD/OFF” range should be selected.

NOTE: Using the “TOW HAUL” or “OD/OFF” rangewhile operating the vehicle under heavy operating con-ditions will improve performance and extend transmis-sion life by reducing excessive shifting and heat build up.This action will also provide better engine braking.

The automatic transmission fluid and filter should bechanged if you REGULARLY tow a trailer for more than45 minutes of continuous operation. See Schedule “B” insection 8 of this manual for transmission fluid changeintervals.

NOTE: Check the automatic transmission fluid levelbefore towing.

Towing Tips — Tow/Haul (If Equipped)To reduce potential for automatic transmission overheat-ing, turn the “TOW HAUL OD/OFF” feature ON whendriving in hilly areas or shift the transmission to Driveposition 2 on more severe grades.

Towing Tips — Electronic Speed Control (IfEquipped)

− Don’t use in hilly terrain or with heavy loads.

− When using the speed control, if you experience speeddrops greater than 10 mph (16 km/h), disengage untilyou can get back to cruising speed.

− Use speed control in flat terrain and with light loads tomaximize fuel efficiency.

STARTING AND OPERATING 265

5

Page 266: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Towing Tips — Cooling SystemTo reduce potential for engine and transmission over-heating, take the following actions:

− City DrivingWhen stopped for short periods of time, put transmissionin neutral and increase engine idle speed.

− Highway DrivingReduce speed.

− Air ConditioningTurn off temporarily.

− refer to Cooling System Operating information in theMaintenance section of this manual for more informa-tion.

Trailer Towing Mirrors — If EquippedThese mirrors are designed with an adjustable mirrorhead to provide a greater vision range when towingextra-wide loads. To change position inboard or out-board, the mirror head should be rotated (flipped Out orIn). A small blindspot mirror is integrated onto the mainmirror surface.

SNOWPLOW

Dodge Dakota Models

NOTE: Do not use Dodge Dakota Models for snowplowapplications.

266 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 267: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Snowplows, winches, and other aftermarket equip-ment should not be added to the front end of yourvehicle. The airbag crash sensors may be affected bythe change in the front end structure. The airbagscould deploy unexpectedly or could fail to deployduring a collision resulting in serious injury ordeath.

CAUTION!

Using this vehicle for snowplow applications cancause damage to the vehicle.

WARNING!

Attaching a snowplow to this vehicle could ad-versely affect performance of the airbag system in anaccident. Do not expect that the airbag will performas described earlier in this manual

RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHINDMOTORHOME, ETC.)

Recreational Towing 2WD ModelsRecreational towing of 2WD models is not allowable-.Towing the vehicle with the transmission in Neutral cancause severe transmission damage.Removal of the drive-shaft for towing is not recommended.

STARTING AND OPERATING 267

5

Page 268: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Recreational Towing 4WD Models

CAUTION!

Internal damage to the transfer case will occur if afront or rear wheel lift is used when recreationaltowing.

CAUTION!

The transfer case must be shifted into Neutral (N) forrecreational towing. The Neutral (N) selection but-ton is located on the lower left hand corner of the4WD Control Switch. Shifts into and out of transfercase Neutral (N) can take place with the selectorswitch in any mode position. Automatic Transmis-sions must be placed in P (Park) position for recre-ational towing. Manual Transmissions must beplaced in gear (for example, 4th gear) for recreationaltowing.

Recreational Towing ProcedureUse the following procedure to prepare your vehicle forrecreational towing.

268 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 269: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

CAUTION!

It is necessary to follow these steps to be certain thatthe transfer case is fully in Neutral (N) beforerecreational towing to prevent damage to internalparts.

1. Bring vehicle to a complete stop.

2. Shut engine OFF.

3. Place ignition key in the ON position.

4. Depress brake pedal.

5. Shift automatic transmission to Neutral (N) or depressclutch on manual transmission.

6. Using the point of a ballpoint pen or similar object,depress the recessed transfer case Neutral (N) button for4 seconds.

7. After shift is completed and the Neutral (N) lightcomes on release Neutral (N) button.

8. Start engine.

9. Shift automatic transmission into Reverse (R).

10. Release brake pedal for five seconds and ensure thatthere is no vehicle movement.

11. Repeat steps 9 and 10 with the transmission in Drive(D).

12. Shut engine OFF and place ignition key to theunlocked OFF position.

13. Shift automatic transmission into Park (P). ShiftManual transmissions into 4th gear.

STARTING AND OPERATING 269

5

Page 270: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

14. Attach vehicle to tow vehicle with tow bar.

NOTE: Items 1 through 5 are requirements that must bemet prior to depressing the Neutral (N) selection button,and must continue to be met until the 4 seconds elapsesand the shift has been completed. If any of these require-ments (with the exception of 3 - Key ON) are not metprior to depressing the Neutral (N) button or are nolonger met during the 4 second timer, then the Neutral(N) indicator light will flash continuously until all re-quirements are met or until the Neutral (N) button isreleased.

NOTE: The ignition key must be ON for a shift to takeplace and for the position indicator lights to be operable.If the key in not ON, the shift will not take place and noposition indicator lights will be on or flashing.

NOTE: Flashing neutral (N) position indicator lightindicates that shift requirements have not been met.

CAUTION!

Damage to the transmission may occur if the trans-mission is shifted into Park (P) with the transfer casein Neutral (N) and the engine RUNNING. With thetransfer case in Neutral (N) ensure that the engine isOFF prior to shifting the transmission into Park (P).

Returning to Normal OperationUse the following procedure to prepare your vehicle fornormal usage.

1. Bring vehicle to a complete stop.

2. Shut engine OFF.

3. Place ignition key in the ON position.

4. Depress brake pedal.

270 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 271: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

5. Shift automatic transmission to Neutral (N) or depressclutch on manual transmission.

6. Using the point of a ballpoint pen or similar object,depress the recessed transfer case Neutral (N) button for1 second.

7. After the Neutral (N) indicator light turns off releasethe Neutral (N) button.

8. After the Neutral (N) button has been released thetransfer case will shift to the position identified by theselector switch.

9. Shift automatic transmission into Drive (D), releasethe clutch on manual transmission.

NOTE: Items 1 through 5 are requirements that must bemet prior to depressing the Neutral (N) selection button,and must continue to be met until 1 second elapses andthe shift has been completed. If any of these requirements(with the exception of 3 - key ON) are not met prior todepressing the Neutral (N) button or are no longer metduring the 1 second time, then all of the mode positionindicator lights will flash continuously until all require-ments are met or until the Neutral (N) button is released.

NOTE: The ignition key must be ON for a shift to takeplace and for the position indicator lights to be operable.If the key is not ON, the shift will not take place and noposition indicator lights will be on or flashing.

NOTE: Flashing neutral (N) position indicator lightindicates that shift requirements have not been met.

STARTING AND OPERATING 271

5

Page 272: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

You or others could be injured if you leave thevehicle unattended with the transfer case in theNeutral (N) position without first fully engaging theparking brake. The transfer case Neutral (N) positiondisengages both the front and rear driveshafts fromthe powertrain and will allow the vehicle to movedespite the transmission position. The parkingbrake should always be applied when the driver isnot in the vehicle.

CAUTION!

• Do not use a bumper mounted clamp-on tow baron your vehicle. The bumper face bar will bedamaged.

• Do not disconnect the rear driveshaft becausefluid will leak from the transfer case and damageinternal parts.

272 STARTING AND OPERATING

Page 273: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

TRACTIONWhen driving on wet or slushy roads, it is possible for awedge of water to build up between the tire and roadsurface. This is known as hydroplaning and may causepartial or complete loss of vehicle control and stoppingability. To reduce this possibility, the following precau-tions should be observed:

1. Slow down during rainstorms or when roads areslushy.

2. Slow down if road has standing water or puddles.

3. Replace tires when tread wear indicators first becomevisible.

4. Keep tires properly inflated.

5. Maintain sufficient distance between your vehicle andthe car in front to avoid a collision in a sudden stop.

EQUIPMENT IDENTIFICATION PLATEThe equipment Identification Plate is located on the hoodinner surface.

The following information about your vehicle is dis-played on this plate: Model, Wheelbase, Vehicle Identifi-cation Number, Truck Order Number, and code numberswith descriptions of all production and special equip-ment on the truck as shipped from the factory.

NOTE: Always refer to the equipment identificationplate when ordering parts.

STARTING AND OPERATING 273

5

Page 274: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys
Page 275: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

CONTENTS

� Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276

� Adding Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276

� Changing A Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277

▫ Jack Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277

▫ Removing The Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279

▫ Tire Changing Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282

� Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287

� Emergency Tow Hooks — If Equipped . . . . . . . . 289

� Towing A Disabled Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290

▫ Four-Wheel Drive Vehicles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290

▫ Two-Wheel Drive Vehicles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291

6

Page 276: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

HAZARD WARNING FLASHERThe flasher switch is on the top of the steering column,just behind the steering wheel. Press the flasher switchand all front and rear directional signals will flashintermittently.

Press the switch a second time to turn off the emergencyflashers.

This is an emergency warning system and should not beused when the vehicle is in motion. Use it when yourvehicle is disabled and is creating a safety hazard forother motorists.

If it is necessary to leave the vehicle to go for service, theflasher system will continue to operate with the ignitionkey removed and the vehicle locked.

ADDING FUELIf using a portable fuel container, it should have a flexiblenozzle long enough to reach past the restriction in thefuel filler tube.

WARNING!

A fire may result if gasoline is pumped into aportable container that is in a vehicle or on a truckbed. You could be burned. Always place gas contain-ers on the ground while filling.

276 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

Page 277: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Remove the gas cap slowly to prevent fuel sprayfrom the filler neck which may cause injury.

The volatility of present gasolines may cause a buildup of pressure in the fuel tank that may increasewhile you drive. This pressure can result in a sprayof gasoline and/or vapors when you remove the capfrom a hot vehicle. Removing the cap slowly allowsthe pressure to vent and prevents fuel spray.

Never allow any lit smoking materials near thevehicle while removing the cap or filling the tank.

Never add fuel to the vehicle when the engine isrunning.

CHANGING A FLAT TIRE

Jack LocationIn the Dakota, the scissor jack and tire changing tools forClub Cab models are stowed in a compartment under therear passenger seat. Quad Cab model scissor jack and tirechanging tools are accessed by lifting up the rear passen-ger seat.

The jack is secured in place by turning the jack screwuntil the jack is secured into place.

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 277

6

Page 278: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

A finger operated helper tool is provided to assist re-moval and stowage of the jack. This tool must beremoved to operate the jack for changing the spare tire.

Jack Stowage Location Extended Cab

Jack Stowage Location Club Cab

278 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

Page 279: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

The jack is designed as a tool for changing tires only.The jack should not be used to lift the vehicle forservice purposes, unless suitable supports are placedunder the vehicle as a safety measure. The vehicleshould be jacked on a firm level surface only. Avoidice or slippery areas.

Removing The Spare TireRemove the spare tire before attempting to jack the truck.Attach the wheel wrench to the jack extension tube. Insertthe tube through the access hole in the rear bumper andinto the winch mechanism tube. Rotate the wheel wrenchhandle counterclockwise until the spare tire is on theground with enough cable slack to allow you to pull itout from under the vehicle. When the spare is clear, tiltthe retainer at the end of the cable and pull it through thecenter of the wheel.

Jack Stowage Location Quad Cab

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 279

6

Page 280: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Steps for Removing the Spare Tire

• Remove the jack from the stowage compartment usingthe supplied finger assist tool.

• Remove the finger assist tool from jack and set asideuntil jack is stowed.

• Assemble the jack tools.

• Locate the tire carrier access hole on the rear bumper.

• Place assembled jack tool extension rod into the accesshole in the direction of the arrow on the bumper trim.

• Rotate the tool counterclockwise to release and lowerthe spare tire to the ground so that it can be pulledfrom under the vehicle.

• Rotate clockwise to stow the spare tire.

Inserting Lug Wrench and Extension

280 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

Page 281: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

It is recommended that you stow the flat or spare toavoid tangling the loose cable.

NOTE: The winch mechanism is designed for use withthe jack extension tube only. Use of an air wrench or otherpower tools is not recommended and can damage thewinch.

Turning Lug Wrench and Extension Spare Tire Stowage Location

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 281

6

Page 282: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Tire Changing Procedure

WARNING!

Getting under a jacked-up vehicle is dangerous. Thevehicle could slip off the jack and fall on you. Youcould be crushed. Never get any part of your bodyunder a vehicle that is on a jack. Never start or runthe engine while the vehicle is on a jack. If you needto get under a raised vehicle, take it to a servicecenter where it can be raised on a lift.

Do not raise this vehicle using a bumper jack. The scissorjack is designed as a tool for changing tires on this vehicleonly. It is not recommended that the jack be used forservice purposes or to lift more than one wheel at a time.

PreparationsPark the vehicle on a firm level surface, avoiding ice orslippery areas. Set the parking brake and place the gearselector in PARK (automatic transmission). On FourWheel Drive vehicles, shift the transfer case to the “4L”position.

WARNING!

Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of thevehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough offthe road to avoid the danger of being hit whenoperating the jack or changing the wheel.

• Turn on the Hazard Warning Flasher.

282 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

Page 283: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• Block both the front and rearof the wheel diagonally oppo-site the jacking position. Forexample, if the right frontwheel is being changed, blockthe left rear wheel.

• Passengers should not remain in the vehicle when thevehicle is being jacked.

Instructions

1. Lower and remove the spare wheel, jack, and toolsfrom stowage.

2. Using the wheel wrench, loosen, but do not remove,the wheel nuts by turning them counterclockwise oneturn while the wheel is still on the ground.

3. When changing a front wheel, place the jack under theframe rail behind the wheel. Locate the jack as farforward as possible on the straight part of the frame priorto inboard transition, as shown. Operate the jack usingthe jack drive tube and the wheel wrench - the tubeextension, may be used but is not required.

Positioning of the Jack Front Wheels

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 283

6

Page 284: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

When changing a rear wheel, assemble the jack drivetube to the jack and connect the drive tube to theextension tube. Place the jack under the axle in thepositions shown with the drive tubes extending to therear. Connect the jack tube extension and wheel wrench.

Before raising the wheel off the ground, make sure thatthe jack will not damage surrounding truck parts andadjust the jack position as required.

4. By rotating the wheel wrench clockwise, raise thevehicle until the wheel just clears the surface.Left Rear Jacking Location

Right Rear Jacking Location

284 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

Page 285: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Raising the vehicle higher than necessary can makethe vehicle unstable and cause an accident. It couldslip off the jack and hurt someone near it. Raise thevehicle only enough to remove the tire.

5. Remove the wheel nuts and pull the wheel off. Installthe spare wheel and wheel nuts with the cone shaped endof the nuts toward the wheel. Lightly tighten the nuts. Toavoid risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack, do not fullytighten the nuts until the vehicle has been lowered.

NOTE: Do not oil wheel studs. For chrome wheels, donot substitute with chrome plated wheel nuts.

6. Using the wheel wrench, finish tightening the nuts ina crisscross pattern. If in doubt about the correct tight-ness, have them checked with a torque wrench by yourdealer or at a service station.

Correct nut tightness is the following:

• Steel Wheels: 130-170 ft. lbs. (177-231 N·m) torque.

• Aluminum Wheels: 120-160 ft. lbs. (163-217 N·m)torque.

WARNING!

A loose tire or jack thrown forward in a collision orhard stop could injure someone in the vehicle.Always stow the jack, tools and the extra tire andwheel in the places provided.

7. Lower the jack to its fully closed position. Stow thereplaced tire, jack, and tools as previously described.

8. Adjust the tire pressure when possible.

NOTE: Do not oil wheel studs. For chrome wheels, donot substitute with chrome plated wheel nuts.

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 285

6

Page 286: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Carefully follow these tire changing warnings to helpprevent personal injury or damage to your vehicle:• Always park on a firm, level surface as far from the edge

of the roadway as possible before raising the vehicle.• Block the wheel diagonally opposite the wheel to be

raised.• Apply the parking brake firmly before jacking.• Never start the engine with the vehicle on a jack.• Do not let anyone sit in the vehicle when it is on a jack.• Do not get under the vehicle when it is on a jack.• Only use the jack in the positions indicated.• If working on or near a roadway, be extremely careful of

motor traffic.• To assure that spare tires, flat or inflated are securely

stowed, spares must be stowed with the value stemfacing the ground.

To Stow The Flat Or SpareTurn the wheel so that the valve stem is down. Slide thewheel retainer through the center of the wheel andposition it properly across the wheel opening.

For convenience in checking the spare tire inflation, stowwith the valve stem toward the rear of the vehicle.

Rotate the winch mechanism until the wheel is drawninto place against the underside of the vehicle. Continueto rotate until you feel the winch mechanism slip or click3 times. It cannot be overtightened. Push against the tireseveral times to be sure it is firmly in place.

To Stow the Flat or Spare: Wheel retainer does not fitthrough the center of the aluminum wheel. The tire mustbe stored in a safe manner in the bed of the truck.

286 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

Page 287: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

JUMP STARTING

WARNING!

• Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution; do notallow battery fluid to contact eyes, skin or cloth-ing. Don’t lean over battery when attachingclamps or allow the clamps to touch each other. Ifacid splashes in eyes or on skin, flush the con-taminated area immediately with large quantitiesof water.

• A battery generates hydrogen gas which is flam-mable and explosive. Keep flame or spark awayfrom the vent holes. Do not use a booster batteryor any other booster source with an output thatexceeds 12 volts.

Check the Battery Test Indicator (if equipped). If a light orbright colored dot is visible in the indicator (if equipped),DO NOT jump-start the battery.

If the indicator (if equipped) is dark or shows a green dot,proceed as follows:

1. Wear eye protection and remove all metal jewelry suchas watch bands or bracelets which might make anunintended electrical contact.

2. Park the booster vehicle within cable reach but with-out letting the vehicles touch. Set the parking brake, placethe automatic transmission in PARK and turn the ignitionOFF on both vehicles.

3. Turn OFF heater, radio and all unnecessary electricalloads.

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 287

6

Page 288: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

4. Connect one end of a jumper cable to the positiveterminal of the booster battery. Connect the other end ofthe same cable to the positive terminal of the dischargedbattery.

WARNING!

Do not permit vehicles to touch each other as thiscould establish a ground connection and personalinjury could result.

5. Connect the other cable, first to the negative terminalof the booster battery and then to the engine of thevehicle with the discharged battery. Make sure you havea good contact on the engine.

WARNING!

Do not connect the cable to the negative post of thedischarge battery. The resulting electrical sparkcould cause the battery to explode.

During cold weather when temperatures are belowfreezing point, electrolyte in a discharged batterymay freeze. Do not attempt jump starting becausethe battery could rupture or explode. The batterytemperature must be brought up above freezingpoint before attempting jump start.

6. Start the engine in the vehicle which has the boosterbattery, let the engine idle a few minutes, then start theengine in the vehicle with the discharged battery.

7. When removing the jumper cables, reverse the abovesequence exactly. Be careful of the moving belts and fan.

288 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

Page 289: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Any procedure other than above could result in:

1. Personal injury caused by electrolyte squirtingout the battery vent;

2. Personal injury or property damage due to batteryexplosion;

3. Damage to charging system of booster vehicle orof immobilized vehicle.

EMERGENCY TOW HOOKS — IF EQUIPPEDYour vehicle may be equipped with emergency towhooks.

WARNING!

Chains are not recommended for freeing a stuckvehicle. Chains may break, causing serious injury ordeath.

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 289

6

Page 290: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Stand clear of vehicles when pulling with towhooks. Tow straps and chains may break, causingserious injury.

CAUTION!

Tow hooks are for emergency use only, to rescue avehicle stranded off road. Do not use tow hooks fortow truck hookup or highway towing. You coulddamage your vehicle.

TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLEProper towing or lifting equipment is required to preventdamage to your vehicle. Use of safety chains is recom-mended. Attach towing device to main structural mem-bers of the vehicle — not to bumpers or associatedbrackets. State and local laws applying to vehiclesunder tow must be observed.

Four-Wheel Drive VehiclesThe manufacturer recommends towing with all wheelsOFF the ground. Acceptable methods are to tow thevehicle on a flatbed or with one end of the vehicle raisedand the opposite end on a towing dolly.

290 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES

Page 291: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Two-Wheel Drive Vehicles

Provided that the transmission is operable, tow with thetransmission in Neutral and the ignition key in the OFFposition along with the front wheels raised and the rearwheels on the ground. The speed must not exceed 30mph (50 km/h) and the distance must not exceed 15miles (25 km).

If the vehicle is to be towed more than 15 miles (25 km ),it must be towed on a flatbed, or with the rear wheelsraised and the front wheels on the ground, or with thefront end raised and the rear wheels on a towing dolly.

NOTE: Towing the vehicle, with the rear wheels on theground, at more than 30 mph (50 km/h) or for more than15 miles (25 km ) can cause severe transmission damage.

WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 291

6

Page 292: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys
Page 293: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

CONTENTS

� Engine Compartment 3.7L V6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296

� Engine Compartment 4.7L/4.7HO V-8 . . . . . . . . 297

� Onboard Diagnostic System — OBD II . . . . . . . . 298

▫ Loose Fuel Filler Cap Message . . . . . . . . . . . . 299

� Emissions Inspection And MaintenancePrograms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299

� Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301

� Dealer Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301

� Maintenance Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302

▫ Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302

▫ Engine Oil Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306

▫ Drive Belts — Check Condition AndTensioner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306

▫ Spark Plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307

▫ Engine Air Cleaner Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307

▫ Engine Fuel Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308

▫ Catalytic Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308

▫ Maintenance-Free Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309

7

Page 294: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

▫ Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311

▫ Power Steering — Fluid Check . . . . . . . . . . . . 312

▫ Front Suspension Ball Joints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312

▫ Drive Shaft Constant Velocity Joints . . . . . . . . 313

▫ Body Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313

▫ Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313

▫ Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314

▫ Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315

▫ Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315

▫ Emission Related Components . . . . . . . . . . . . 320

▫ Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321

▫ Clutch Hydraulic System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323

▫ Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323

▫ Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324

▫ Transfer Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326

▫ Axles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327

▫ Selection Of Lubricating Grease . . . . . . . . . . . 327

▫ Appearance Care And Protection FromCorrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328

� Power Distribution Center (Fuse/Relay) . . . . . . . 332

� Vehicle Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333

� Replacement Light Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334

� Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334

▫ Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334

▫ Front Park And Turn Signal Lamp. . . . . . . . . . 338

▫ Rear Side Marker, Taillamps/Stoplamp,And Turn Signal Bulbs — Replacement . . . . . . 340

294 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 295: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

▫ Center High-Mounted Stoplamp AndCargo Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342

▫ License Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345

▫ Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346

� Fluids And Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347

� Fluids, Lubricants And Genuine Parts . . . . . . . . 348

▫ Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348

▫ Chassis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 295

7

Page 296: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

ENGINE COMPARTMENT 3.7L V6

296 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 297: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

ENGINE COMPARTMENT 4.7L/4.7HO V-8

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 297

7

Page 298: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD IIYour vehicle is equipped with a sophisticated onboarddiagnostic system called OBD II. This system monitorsthe performance of the emissions, engine, and automatictransmission control systems. When these systems areoperating properly, your vehicle will provide excellentperformance and fuel economy, as well as engine emis-sions well within current government regulations.

If any of these systems require service, the OBD II systemwill turn on the “Malfunction Indicator Light.” It willalso store diagnostic codes and other information toassist your service technician in making repairs. Al-though your vehicle will usually be drivable and notneed towing, see your dealer for service as soon aspossible.

CAUTION!

• Prolonged driving with the “Malfunction Indica-tor Light” on could cause further damage to theemission control system. It could also affect fueleconomy and driveability. The vehicle must beserviced before any emissions tests can be per-formed.

• If the “Malfunction Indicator Light” is flashingwhile the engine is running, severe catalytic con-verter damage and power loss will soon occur.Immediate service is required.

298 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 299: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Loose Fuel Filler Cap MessageAfter fuel is added, the vehicle diagnostic system candetermine if the fuel filler cap is loose, improperlyinstalled, or damaged. A loose fuel filler cap message willbe displayed in the instrument cluster. Tighten the gascap until a �clicking� sound is heard. This is an indicationthat the gas cap is properly tightened. Press the odometerreset button to turn the message off. If the problempersists, the message will appear the next time thevehicle is started. This might indicate a damaged cap. Ifthe problem is detected twice in a row, the system willturn on the Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL). Resolvingthe problem will turn the MIL light off.

EMISSIONS INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCEPROGRAMSIn some localities, it may be a legal requirement to passan inspection of your vehicle’s emissions control system.Failure to pass could prevent vehicle registration.

For states which have an I/M (Inspection andMaintenance) requirement, this check verifies thefollowing: the MIL (Malfunction Indicator Lamp)

is functioning and is not on when the engine is running,and that the OBD (On Board Diagnostic) system is readyfor testing.

Normally, the OBD system will be ready. The OBDsystem may not be ready if your vehicle was recentlyserviced, if you recently had a dead battery, or a batteryreplacement. If the OBD system is determined not readyfor the I/M test, your vehicle may fail the test.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 299

7

Page 300: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Your vehicle has a simple ignition key actuated testwhich you can use prior to going to the test station. Tocheck if your vehicle’s OBD system is ready, you must dothe following:

1. Insert your ignition key into the ignition switch.

2. Turn the ignition to the ON position, but do not crankor start the engine. If you crank or start the engine, youwill have to start this test over.

3. As soon as you turn your key to the ON position, youwill see your MIL symbol come on as part of a normalbulb check.

4. Approximately 15 seconds later, one of two things willhappen:

a. The MIL light will blink for approximately 5 sec-onds and then remain on until the first engine crank or

the key is turned off. This means that your vehicle’sOBD system is not ready and you should not proceedto the I/M station.

b. The MIL light will remain fully illuminated until thefirst engine crank or the key is turned off. This meansthat your vehicle’s OBD system is ready and you canproceed to the I/M station.

If your OBD system is not ready you should see yourdealer or repair facility. If your vehicle was recentlyserviced or had a battery failure or replacement, you mayneed to do nothing more than drive your vehicle as younormally would in order for your OBD system to update.A recheck with the above test routine may then indicatethat the system is now ready.

Regardless of whether your vehicle’s OBD system isready or not ready, if the MIL symbol is illuminatedduring normal vehicle operation, you should have your

300 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 301: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

vehicle serviced before going to the I/M station. The I/Mstation can fail your vehicle because the MIL symbol is onwith the engine running.

REPLACEMENT PARTSUse of genuine Mopar� parts for normal/scheduledmaintenance and repairs is highly recommended to in-sure the designed performance. Damage or failurescaused by the use of non-Mopar� parts for maintenanceand repairs will not be covered by the manufacturer’swarranty.

DEALER SERVICEYour dealer has the qualified service personnel, specialtools and equipment to perform all service operations inan expert manner. Service manuals are available whichinclude detailed service information for your vehicle.Refer to these manuals before attempting any procedureyourself.

NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions controlsystems can result in civil penalties being assessedagainst you.

WARNING!

You can be badly injured working on or around amotor vehicle. Do only that service work for whichyou have the knowledge and the proper equipment.If you have any doubt about your ability to performa service job, take your vehicle to a competentmechanic.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 301

7

Page 302: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

MAINTENANCE PROCEDURESThe pages that follow contain the required maintenanceservices determined by the engineers who designed yourvehicle.

Besides the maintenance items for which there are fixedmaintenance intervals, there are other items that shouldoperate satisfactorily without periodic maintenance.However, if a malfunction of these items does occur, itcould adversely affect the engine or vehicle performance.These items should be inspected if a malfunction isobserved or suspected.

Engine Oil

Checking Engine Oil LevelTo assure proper lubrication of your vehicle’s engine, theengine oil must be maintained at the correct level. Thebest time to check the engine oil level is about 5 minutesafter a fully warmed up engine is shut off or beforestarting the engine after it has sat overnight.

1. Position the vehicle on a level surface.

2. Turn Off the engine and allow approximately 5 min-utes for the oil to settle to the bottom of the crankcase.

3. Remove the engine oil level indicator (dipstick).

4. Wipe the engine oil level indicator (dipstick) clean.

5. Install the engine oil level indicator (dipstick) andmake sure it is seated in the tube.

6. Remove the engine oil level indicator (dipstick), keep-ing the handle above the tip, and read the oil level on theengine oil level indicator (dipstick).

7. Add oil only if the level is below the “SAFE” range (ator below the “ADD” mark) on the engine oil levelindicator (dipstick). Adding one quart of oil when thereading is at the ADD mark will result in a reading at thetop of the SAFE zone on these engines.

302 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 303: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

CAUTION!

Overfilling or underfilling the crankcase will causeoil aeration or loss of oil pressure. This could dam-age your engine.

Frequency Of Oil ChangeRoad conditions and your style of driving affect theinterval at which your oil should be changed. Check thefollowing to determine if ANY apply to you:

• Day or night temperatures are below 32°F (0°C).

• Stop and Go driving.

• Extensive engine idling.

• Driving in dusty conditions.

• Short trips of less than 10 miles (16.2 km).

• More than 50% of your driving is at sustained highspeeds during hot weather, above 90°F (32°C).

• Trailer towing, Taxi, Police or delivery service (com-mercial service).

• Off-Road or desert operation.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 303

7

Page 304: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• If equipped for and operating with E-85 (ethanol)fuel.

NOTE: If ANY of these apply to you then change yourengine oil every 3,000 miles (5 000 km) or 3 months,whichever comes first and follow schedule “B” of the�Maintenance Schedules� section of this manual.

If NONE of these apply to you, then change your engineoil every 6,000 miles (10 000 km) or 6 months, whichevercomes first and follow schedule �A� of the �MaintenanceSchedules� section of this manual.

4x4 Models, If Used Primarily For Off-Road OperationEvery 50 hours of use.

Dusty ConditionsDriving through dust-laden air increases the problems ofkeeping abrasive materials out of the engine. Under theseconditions, special attention should be given to theengine air cleaner. The crankcase ventilation system

should also be checked periodically. Make sure that theseunits are always clean. This will tend to reduce to aminimum the amount of abrasive material that may enterthe engine.

Engine Oil SelectionFor best performance and maximum protection under alltypes of operating conditions, the manufacture onlyrecommends engine oils that are API certified and meetthe requirements of DaimlerChrysler Material StandardMS-6395. Use Mopar or an equivalent oil meeting thespecification MS-6395.

Engine Oil Identification (API) SymbolThere is a symbol to aid you in selecting the properengine oil.

304 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 305: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

This symbol means that the oil hasbeen certified by the AmericanPetroleum Institute (API). Themanufacture only recommendsAPI Certified engine oils thatmeet the requirements ofDaimlerChrysler Material Stan-dard MS-6395. Use Mopar or anequivalent oil meeting the specifi-

cation MS-6395.

Engine Oil Viscosity (SAE Grade)SAE 5W-30 engine oil is recommended for all operatingtemperatures. This engine oil improves low tempera-ture starting and vehicle fuel economy. Refer to yourengine oil filler cap for the recommended engine oilviscosity for your vehicle.

For information on engine oil filler cap location, see theEngine Compartment illustration in this section.

Lubricants which do not have both, the engine oil certi-fication mark and the correct SAE viscosity grade num-ber should not be used.

Synthetic Engine OilsThere are a number of engine oils being promoted aseither synthetic or semi-synthetic. If you chose to usesuch a product, use only those oils that meet the Ameri-can Petroleum Institute (API) and SAE viscosity stan-dard. Follow the service schedule that describes yourdriving type.

Materials Added to Engine OilsThe manufacture strongly recommends against the addi-tion of any additives (other than leak detection dyes) tothe engine oil. Engine oil is an engineered product andit’s performance may be impaired by supplemental ad-ditives.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 305

7

Page 306: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Disposing of Used Engine Oil And Oil FiltersCare should be taken in disposing of used engine oil andoil filters from your vehicle. Used oil and oil filters,indiscriminately discarded, can present a problem to theenvironment. Contact your dealer, service station, orgovernmental agency for advice on how and where usedoil and oil filters can be safely discarded in your area.

Engine Oil FilterThe engine oil filter should be replaced at every engineoil change.

Engine Oil Filter SelectionThe manufacturer’s engines have a full-flow type oilfilter. Use a filter of this type for replacement. The qualityof replacement filters varies considerably. Only highquality filters should be used to assure most efficientservice. Mopar� Engine Oil Filters are a high quality oilfilter and are recommended.

Drive Belts — Check Condition and TensionerBelt tension is controlled by means of an automatictensioner. No belt tension adjustments are required.However, belt and belt tensioner condition should beinspected at the specified intervals, and replaced if re-quired. See your authorized dealer for service

At the mileage indicated in the maintenance schedule, allbelts and tensioner should be checked for condition.Improper belt tension can cause belt slippage and failure.

Belts should be inspected for evidence of cuts, cracks,glazing, or frayed cords and replaced if there is indicationof damage which could result in belt failure. Low gen-erator belt tension can cause battery failure.

Also check belt routing to make sure there is no interfer-ence between the belts and other engine components.

306 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 307: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Spark PlugsSpark plugs must fire properly to assure proper engineperformance and emission control. The plugs installed inyour vehicle should operate satisfactorily in normalservice for the mileage indicated in the MaintenanceChart. New plugs should be installed at this mileage. Theentire set should be replaced if there is any malfunctiondue to a faulty spark plug. Check the Vehicle EmissionsControl Information label for the proper type of sparkplug for your vehicle.

CAUTION!

When replacing plugs, do not overtighten. You coulddamage them and cause them to leak.

Engine Air Cleaner FilterUnder normal driving conditions, replace the air filter atthe intervals shown on Schedule “A”. If, however, youdrive the vehicle frequently under dusty or severe con-ditions, the filter element should be inspected periodi-cally and replaced if necessary at the intervals shown onSchedule “B”.

WARNING!

The air cleaner can provide a measure of protectionin the case of engine backfire. Do not remove the aircleaner unless such removal is necessary for repair ormaintenance. Make sure that no one is near theengine compartment before starting the vehicle withthe air cleaner removed. Failure to do so can result inserious personal injury.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 307

7

Page 308: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Engine Fuel FilterA plugged fuel filter can cause stalling, limit the speed atwhich a vehicle can be driven or cause hard starting.Should an excessive amount of dirt accumulate in thefuel tank, frequent filter replacement may be necessary.

Catalytic ConverterThe catalytic converter requires the use of unleaded fuelonly. Leaded gasoline will destroy the effectiveness of thecatalyst as an emission control device.

Under normal operating conditions, the catalytic con-verter will not require maintenance. However, it is im-portant to keep the engine properly tuned to assureproper catalyst operation and prevent possible catalystdamage.

CAUTION!

Damage to the catalytic converter can result if yourvehicle is not kept in proper operating condition. Inthe event of engine malfunction, particularly involv-ing engine misfire or other apparent loss of perfor-mance, have your vehicle serviced promptly. Contin-ued operation of your vehicle with a severemalfunction could cause the converter to overheat,resulting in possible damage to the converter and thevehicle.

NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions controlsystems can result in civil penalties being assessedagainst you.

308 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 309: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

A hot exhaust system can start a fire if you park overmaterials that can burn. Such materials might begrass or leaves coming into contact with your ex-haust system. Do not park or operate your vehicle inareas where your exhaust system can contact any-thing that can burn.

In unusual situations involving grossly malfunctioningengine operation, a scorching odor may indicate severeand abnormal catalyst overheating. If this occurs, thevehicle should be stopped, the engine shut off and thevehicle allowed to cool. Thereafter, service, including atune-up to manufacturer’s specifications, should be ob-tained immediately.

To minimize the possibility of catalyst damage:

• Do not shut off the engine or interrupt the ignitionwhen the transmission is in gear and the vehicle is inmotion.

• Do not try to start engine by pushing or towing thevehicle.

• Do not idle the engine with any spark plug wiresdisconnected or removed, such as when diagnostictesting, or for prolonged periods during very roughidling or malfunctioning operating conditions.

Maintenance-Free BatteryAll Dodge trucks are equipped with maintenance-freebatteries. You will never have to add water, nor isperiodic maintenance required.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 309

7

Page 310: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories con-tain lead and lead compounds. Always wash handsafter handling the battery.

To determine the battery charge, check the battery testindicator (if equipped) on top of the battery. Refer to theillustration.

CAUTION!

It is essential when replacing the cables on thebattery that the positive cable is attached to thepositive post and the negative cable is attached to thenegative post. Battery posts are marked (+) positiveand negative (-) and identified on the battery case.Also, if a “fast charger” is used while battery is in thevehicle, disconnect both vehicle battery cables be-fore connecting the charger to battery. Do not use a“fast charger” to provide starting voltage.

310 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 311: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Air Conditioner MaintenanceFor best possible performance, your air conditionershould be checked and serviced by an Authorized Dealerat the start of each warm season. This service shouldinclude cleaning of the condenser fins and a performancetest. Drive belt tension should also be checked at thistime.

WARNING!

• Use only refrigerants and compressor lubricantsapproved by the manufacturer for your air condi-tioning system. Some unapproved refrigerants areflammable and can explode, injuring you. Otherunapproved refrigerants or lubricants can causethe system to fail, requiring costly repairs. Referto Section 3 of the Warranty Information book forfurther warranty information.

• The air conditioning system contains refrigerantunder high pressure. To avoid risk of personalinjury or damage to the system, adding refrigerantor any repair requiring lines to be disconnectedshould be done by an experienced repairman.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 311

7

Page 312: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Refrigerant Recovery and RecyclingR-134a Air Conditioning Refrigerant is a hydrofluorocar-bon (HFC) that is endorsed by the Environmental Pro-tection Agency and is an ozone-saving product. How-ever, the manufacturer recommends that air conditioningservice be performed by dealers or other service facilitiesusing recovery and recycling equipment.

Power Steering — Fluid CheckChecking the power steering fluid level at a definedservice interval is not required. The fluid should only bechecked if a leak is suspected, abnormal noises areapparent, and/or the system is not functioning as antici-pated. Coordinate inspection efforts through a certifiedDaimlerChrysler Dealership.�

WARNING!

Fluid level should be checked on a level surface andwith the engine off to prevent injury from movingparts and to insure accurate fluid level reading. Donot overfill. Use only manufacturers recommendedpower steering fluid.

If necessary, add fluid to restore to the proper indicatedlevel. With a clean cloth, wipe any spilled fluid from allsurfaces. Refer to Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Partsfor correct fluid type.

Front Suspension Ball JointsThe ball joints and seals should be inspected wheneverthe vehicle is serviced for other reasons. Damaged sealsshould be replaced to prevent leakage or contaminationof the grease.

312 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 313: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Drive Shaft Constant Velocity JointsAll four wheel drive models are equipped with fourconstant velocity joints. Periodic lubrication of thesejoints is not required. However, the joint boot should beinspected for external leakage or damage periodically. Ifexternal leakage or damage is evident, the joint boot andgrease should be replaced immediately. Continued op-eration could result in failure of the joint due to waterand dirt contamination of the grease. This would requirecomplete replacement of the joint assembly. Refer to theService Manual for the detailed replacement procedure.

Body LubricationLocks and all body pivot points, including such items asseat tracks, doors and hood hinges, should be lubricatedperiodically to assure quiet, easy operation and to protectagainst rust and wear. Prior to the application of anylubricant, the parts concerned should be wiped clean toremove dust and grit; after lubricating excess oil andgrease should be removed. Particular attention should

also be given to hood latching components to insureproper function. When performing other underhood ser-vices, the hood latch, release mechanism and safety catchshould be cleaned and lubricated.

The external lock cylinders should be lubricated twice ayear, preferably in the fall and spring. Apply a smallamount of a high quality lubricant such as Mopar� LockCylinder Lubricant directly into the lock cylinder.

Windshield Wiper BladesThe rubber edges of the wiper blades and the windshieldshould be cleaned periodically with a sponge or soft clothand a mild nonabrasive cleaner. This will remove accu-mulations of salt or road film.

Operation of the wipers on dry glass for long periodsmay cause deterioration of the wiper blades. Always usewasher fluid when using the wipers to remove salt or dirtfrom a dry windshield.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 313

7

Page 314: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Avoid using the wiper blades to remove frost or ice fromthe windshield. Keep the blade rubber out of contact withpetroleum products such as engine oil, gasoline, etc.

Windshield WashersThe fluid reservoir should be checked for fluid level atregular intervals. When freezing weather is anticipated,flush out the water in the reservoir by operating thesystem. Fill the reservoir with windshield washer anti-freeze (not radiator antifreeze), and operate the systemfor a few seconds to flush out the residual water.

To prevent freeze-up of your windshield washer systemin cold weather, select a solution or mixture that meets orexceeds the temperature range of your climate. Thisrating information can be found on most washer fluidcontainers.

WARNING!

Commercially available windshield washer solventsare flammable. They could ignite and burn you. Caremust be exercised when filling or working aroundthe washer solution.

After the engine has warmed, operate the defroster for afew minutes to reduce the possibility of smearing orfreezing the fluid on the cold windshield. Mopar� AllWeather Windshield Washer Solution used with water asdirected on the container, aids cleaning action, reducesfreezing point to avoid line clogging, and is not harmfulto paint or trim.

314 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 315: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Exhaust SystemThe best protection against carbon monoxide entry intothe vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaustsystem.

Whenever a change is noticed in the sound of the exhaustsystem, when exhaust fumes can be detected inside thevehicle, or when the underside or rear of the vehicle isdamaged, have a competent mechanic inspect the com-plete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken,damaged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Openseams or loose connections could permit exhaust fumesto seep into the passenger compartment. In addition,inspect the exhaust system each time the vehicle is raisedfor lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.

WARNING!

Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain carbonmonoxide (CO) which is colorless and odorless.Breathing it can make you unconscious and caneventually poison you. To avoid breathing CO, fol-low the preceding safety tips.

Cooling System

InspectionCoolant protection checks should be made at every 12months (before the onset of freezing weather, whereapplicable). If coolant is dirty or rusty in appearance, thesystem should be drained, flushed and refilled with freshcoolant. Check face of radiator for any accumulation ofbugs, leaves, etc. If dirty, clean the radiator core by gentlyspraying water from a garden hose at the back of the core.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 315

7

Page 316: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Check the coolant bottle tubing for condition and tight-ness of connection at coolant bottle and radiator. Inspectthe entire system for leaks.

WARNING!

You or others can be badly burned by hot coolant orsteam from your radiator. If you see or hear steamcoming from under the hood don’t open the hooduntil the radiator has had time to cool. If you openthe hood and see steam or hot coolant escaping fromthe radiator, don’t touch anything. Get away quickly.Never try to open a pressure cap when the radiator ishot.

Cooling System MaintenanceAt the intervals shown in the Maintenance Schedulessection of this manual, the system should be drained,flushed and refilled. See your authorized dealer forproper cooling system maintenance.

Cooling System — Drain, Flush And RefillIf the solution is dirty and contains a considerableamount of sediment, it should be cleaned and flushed.See your authorized dealer for proper draining, flushingand refilling of your vehicle’s cooling system.

316 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 317: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Disposal of Used Engine CoolantUsed ethylene glycol based engine coolant is a regulatedsubstance requiring proper disposal. Check with yourlocal authorities to determine the disposal rules for yourcommunity. Do not store ethylene glycol based enginecoolant in open containers or allow it to remain inpuddles on the ground. Prevent ingestion by animals andchildren. If ingested, contact a physician or poison con-trol specialist in your area. Clean up any ground spillsimmediately.

Recommended Engine CoolantThis vehicle has been factory filled with an EthyleneGlycol based engine coolant with long life corrosioninhibitors (called HOAT, for Hybrid Organic AdditiveTechnology). Follow the “Maintenance Schedule” for therecommended coolant change intervals. Refer to Fluids,Lubricants and Genuine Parts for correct fluid type.

CAUTION!

Mixing of coolants other than specified (non-HOAT), may result in engine damage and decreasedcorrosion protection. If a non-HOAT coolant is intro-duced into the cooling system in an emergency, itshould be replaced with the specified coolant assoon as possible.

Do not use plain water alone or alcohol base anti-freeze products. Do not use additional rust inhibi-tors or antirust products, as they may not be compat-ible with the radiator coolant and may plug theradiator.

This vehicle has not been designed for use withPropylene Glycol based coolants. Use of PropyleneGlycol based coolants is not recommended.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 317

7

Page 318: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Adding CoolantWhen adding coolant, or refilling the system, a minimumsolution of 50% recommended HOAT ethylene glycolengine coolant (antifreeze) and distilled water should beused. Use higher concentrations (not to exceed 70%) iftemperatures below �34°F (�37°C) are anticipated.

Use only high purity water such as distilled or deionizedwater when mixing the water/engine coolant solution.The use of lower quality water will reduce the amount ofcorrosion protection in the engine cooling system.

Please note that it is the owner’s responsibility to main-tain the proper level of protection against freezing ac-cording to the temperatures occurring in the area wherethe vehicle is operated.

NOTE: Mixing coolant types will decrease the life of theengine coolant and will require more frequent coolantchanges.

WARNING!

Never add coolant to the radiator when the engine isoverheated. Do not loosen or remove pressure cap tocool overheated engine. The coolant is under pres-sure and severe scalding could result.

Coolant Pressure CapThe coolant pressure cap must be fully tightened toprevent loss of coolant, and to insure that coolant willreturn to the radiator from the coolant bottle.

The pressure cap should be inspected and cleaned if thereis any accumulation of foreign material on the sealingsurfaces.

318 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 319: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

The warning words “DO NOT OPEN HOT” on thecoolant pressure cap are a safety precaution. Heatcauses pressure to build up in the cooling system. Toprevent scalding or injury, do not remove the pres-sure cap when the system is hot or under pressure.

Coolant LevelThe coolant bottle system provides a quick visual methodfor determining that the coolant level is adequate. Withthe engine idling, and warmed to normal operatingtemperature,� the level of the coolant on the overflowbottle should be between the fluid level marks.� Checkthe coolant level whenever the hood is raised.

The radiator normally remains completely full, so there isno need to remove the pressure cap except checkingcoolant freeze point or replacement with new antifreeze

coolant. Your service attendant should be advised of this.When additional coolant is needed to maintain theproper level, it should be added to the coolant bottle. Donot overfill.

Points To Remember

A. Do not overfill the coolant bottle.

B. Check coolant freeze point in the radiator and in thecoolant bottle. If antifreeze needs to be added, contents ofcoolant bottle also must be protected against freezing.

C. If frequent coolant additions are required, or if thelevel in the coolant bottle does not drop when the enginecools, the cooling system should be pressure tested forleaks.

D. Maintain a minimum coolant concentration of 50%ethylene glycol and distilled water.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 319

7

Page 320: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

E. Make sure that the radiator and coolant bottle over-flow hoses are not kinked or obstructed.

F. Keep the front of the radiator clean. If your vehicle isequipped with air conditioning, keep the front of thecondenser clean also.

G. The thermostat should not be changed for summer orwinter operation. If replacement is ever necessary, installONLY the correct type thermostat. Other designs mayresult in unsatisfactory cooling performance.

Emission Related Components

Fuel System Hoses And Vapor/Vacuum HarnessesWhen the vehicle is serviced for scheduled maintenance,inspect surface of hoses and nylon tubing for evidence ofheat and mechanical damage. Hard and brittle rubber,cracking, checking, tears, cuts, abrasions, and excessiveswelling suggest deterioration of the rubber. Particular

attention should be given to examining hose surfacesnearest to high heat sources, such as the exhaust mani-fold.

Insure nylon tubing in these areas has not melted orcollapsed.

Inspect all hose clamps and couplings to make sure theyare secure and no leaks are present.

You are urged to use only the manufacturer’s specifiedhoses and clamps, or their equivalent in material andspecification, in any fuel system servicing. It is manda-tory to replace all clamps that have been loosened orremoved during service. Care should be taken in install-ing new clamps to insure they are properly torqued.

Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) ValveProper operation of the crankcase ventilation systemrequires that the PCV valve be free of sticking or plug-ging because of deposits. Deposits can accumulate in the

320 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 321: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

PCV valve and passage with increasing mileage. Havethe PCV valve, hoses, and passages checked for properoperation at the intervals specified. If the valve isplugged or sticking, replace with a new valve – Do notattempt to clean the oil PCV valve! Check ventilatinghose for indication of damage or plugging with deposits.Replace if necessary.

Brake System

Power Disc Brakes (Front)Disc brakes do not require adjustment; however, severalhard stops during the break-in period are recommendedto seat the linings and wear off any foreign material.

Brake Master CylindersThe fluid level in the master cylinders should be checkedwhenever the vehicle is serviced, or immediately if thebrake system warning light is on. If necessary, add fluidto bring level to the full mark on the side of the reservoirof the brake master cylinder. Be sure to clean the top ofthe master cylinder area before removing the cap. Withdisc brakes, fluid level can be expected to fall as the brakepads wear. Brake fluid level should be checked whenpads are replaced. If the brake fluid level is abnormallylow, check system for leaks.

Refer to Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts for correctfluid type.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 321

7

Page 322: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARNING!

Use of brake fluid that may have a lower initialboiling point, or is unidentified as to specifications,may result in sudden brake failure during hardprolonged braking. You could have an accident.

WARNING!

Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result inspilling brake fluid on hot engine parts and thebrake fluid catching fire.

Use only brake fluid that has been in a tightly closedcontainer to avoid contamination from foreign matter ormoisture.

CAUTION!

Do not allow a petroleum-base fluid to contaminatethe brake fluid. Seal damage may result.

Brake LiningsYour vehicle is equipped with self-adjusting brakes.During normal driving, a few brake applications whilemoving in reverse will maintain your brakes at thespecified adjustment. Adjustment will continue until thebrake linings are worn. To avoid brake failure, brake pullor damage to the rotors or drums, inspect the brakelinings as specified in the maintenance schedule. Ifexcessively worn, the brake linings must be replaced.

322 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 323: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Brake HosesInspection should be performed whenever the brakesystem is serviced or at intervals specified. Inspect hy-draulic brake hoses for surface cracking, scuffing or wornspots. If there is any evidence of cracking, scuffing, orworn spots, the hose should be replaced immediately!Eventual deterioration of the hose can take place withpossible burst failure.

WARNING!

Worn brake hoses can burst and cause brake failure.You could have an accident. If you see any sign ofcracking, scuffing, or worn spots, have the brakehoses replaced immediately.

Clutch Hydraulic SystemThe clutch hydraulic system is a sealed maintenance freesystem. In the event of leakage or other malfunction, thesystem must be replaced.

Manual Transmission

Fluid Level CheckThis fluid should be checked whenever other underhoodservices are performed. The fluid level is checked byremoving the fill plug. If the level of the lubricant is morethan 1/4� (6.35 mm) below the bottom of the filler holewhile the vehicle is level, enough lubricant should beadded to bring the level to the bottom of the filler hole.This fluid does not require periodic changing. However,if it becomes necessary to add or replace the fluid in thesetransmissions, refer to Fluids, Lubricants and GenuineParts for correct fluid type.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 323

7

Page 324: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Automatic Transmission

Fluid Level CheckCheck the fluid level while the transmission is at normaloperating temperature 180°F (82°C). This occurs after atleast 15 miles (24 km) of driving. At normal operatingtemperature the fluid cannot be held comfortably be-tween the fingertips.

To check the automatic transmission fluid level properly,the following procedure must be used:

1. Operate the engine at idle speed and normal operatingtemperature.

2. The vehicle must be on level ground.

3. Fully apply the parking brake and press the brakepedal.

4. Place the gear selector momentarily in each gearposition ending with the lever in P (Park).

5. Remove the dipstick, wipe it clean and reinsert it untilseated.

6. Remove the dipstick again and note the fluid level onboth sides. The fluid level should be between the “HOT”(upper) reference holes on the dipstick at normal operat-ing temperature. Verify that solid coating of oil is seen onboth sides of the dipstick. If the fluid is low, add asrequired into the dipstick tube. Do not overfill. Afteradding any quantity of oil through the oil fill tube, waita minimum of two (2) minutes for the oil to fully draininto the transmission before rechecking the fluid level.

NOTE: If it is necessary to check the transmission belowthe operating temperature, the fluid level should bebetween the two “COLD” (lower) holes on the dipstickwith the fluid at approximately 70°F ( 21°C) (roomtemperature). If the fluid level is correctly established atroom temperature, it should be between the “HOT”

324 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 325: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

(upper) reference holes when the transmission reaches180°F ( 82°C). Remember it is best to check the level at thenormal operating temperature.

CAUTION!

Be aware that if the fluid temperature is below 50°F(10°C) it may not register on the dipstick. Do not addfluid until the temperature is elevated enough toproduce an accurate reading.

7. Check for leaks. Release parking brake.

To prevent dirt and water from entering the transmissionafter checking or replenishing fluid, make certain that thedipstick cap is properly reseated. It is normal for thedipstick cap to spring back slightly from its fully seatedposition, as long as its seal remains engaged in thedipstick tube.

Automatic Transmission Fluid And Filter ChangeTo obtain best performance and long life for automatictransmissions, the manufacturer recommends that theybe given regular maintenance service by an AuthorizedDodge Dealer or Service Center. It is important that thetransmission fluid be maintained at the correct level andthat it be drained and refilled as specified.

Follow the proper Maintenance Schedule for your type ofdriving.

It is important that proper lubricant is used in thetransmission. Refer to Fluids, Lubricants and GenuineParts for correct fluid type. It is important that thetransmission fluid be maintained at the prescribed levelusing the recommended fluid.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 325

7

Page 326: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

CAUTION!

Using a transmission fluid other than the manufac-turers recommended fluid may cause deteriorationin transmission shift quality and/or torque convertershudder. Using a transmission fluid other than themanufacturers recommended fluid will result inmore frequent fluid and filter changes. Refer toFluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts for correctfluid type.

Special AdditivesThe manufacturer strongly recommends against the ad-dition of any additives to the transmission. Exception tothis policy is the use of special dyes to aid in detectingfluid leaks. The use of transmission sealers should beavoided, since they may adversely affect seals.

Transfer CaseInspect the transfer case for fluid leaks. If a fluid leak isevident the transfer case fluid level may be low. Have thetransfer case serviced immediately.

CAUTION!

Damage may result from operation of the vehiclewith low transfer case fluid.

The transfer case fluid should be drained and refilled atthe intervals specified.

Lubricant SelectionRefer to Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts for correctfluid type.

326 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 327: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

AxlesRefer to Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts for correctfluid type.

The manufacturer does not recommend regularly sched-uled oil changes for axles in vehicles whose operation isclassified as normal truck service.

NOTE: The presence of water in the gear lubricant willresult in corrosion and possible failure of differentialcomponents. Operation of the vehicle in water, as may beencountered in some off-highway types of service, willrequire draining and refilling the axle to avoid damage.

Rear AxleRear Axle Limited-slip differentials require the use ofMopar limited-slip additive. Refer to Fluids, Lubricantsand Genuine Parts for correct fluid type. This should beadded to the gear lubricant whenever a fluid change ismade, when equipped with limited-slip differential. Rear

axle fluid level should be 1/4� (6.35mm) below filler plughole for 8 1/4� axles and should be 5/8� (16mm) belowfiller plug for 9 1/4� axles.

Front AxleFront Axle fluid level should be at the bottom of the fillplug.

Selection of Lubricating GreaseThe National Lubricating Grease Institute (NLGI) hasdeveloped a symbol (Certification Mark) to aid thevehicle owner in the proper selection of grease for chassiscomponents. This symbol, an example shown below, islocated on the grease container and identifies the appli-cation and quality of the grease.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 327

7

Page 328: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

There are two groupsidentified, those for wheelbearings (Letter “G”) andthose for chassis (Letter“L”) lubrication. Perfor-mance categories withinthese groups result in dualletter designations foreach group. The letter des-ignations shown in the ex-ample are the highest

quality level available and when combined as shown canbe used for chassis lubrication. Use only those greasesthat have the NLGI symbol on the container along withthe proper quality level for your application.

Appearance Care and Protection from Corrosion

Protection of Body and Paint from CorrosionVehicle body care requirements vary according to geo-graphic locations and usage. Chemicals that make roadspassable in snow and ice, and those that are sprayed ontrees and road surfaces during other seasons, are highlycorrosive to the metal in your vehicle. Outside parking,which exposes your vehicle to airborne contaminants,road surfaces on which the vehicle is operated, extremehot or cold weather and other extreme conditions willhave an adverse effect on paint, metal trim, and under-body protection.

The following maintenance recommendations will enableyou to obtain maximum benefit from the corrosionresistance built into your vehicle.

What Causes Corrosion?Corrosion is the result of deterioration or removal ofpaint and protective coatings from your vehicle.

328 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 329: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

The most common causes are:

• Road salt, dirt and moisture accumulation.

• Stone and gravel impact.

• Insects, tree sap and tar.

• Salt in the air near seacoast localities.

• Atmospheric fallout/industrial pollutants.

Washing

• Wash your vehicle regularly. Always wash your ve-hicle in the shade using a mild car wash soap, andrinse the panels completely with clear water.

• If insects, tar or other similar deposits have accumu-lated on your vehicle, wash it as soon as possible.

• Use Mopar� auto polish to remove road film andstains and to polish your vehicle. Take care never toscratch the paint.

• Avoid using abrasive compounds and power buffingthat may diminish the gloss or thin out the paintfinish.

CAUTION!

Do not use abrasive or strong cleaning materialssuch as steel wool or scouring powder, which willscratch metal and painted surfaces.

Special Care

• If you drive on salted or dusty roads or if you drivenear the ocean, hose off the undercarriage at least oncea month.

• It is important that the drain holes in the lower edgesof the doors, rocker panels be kept clear and open.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 329

7

Page 330: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• If you detect any stone chips or scratches in the paint,touch them up immediately. The cost of such repairs isconsidered the responsibility of the owner.

• If your vehicle is damaged due to an accident orsimilar cause which destroys the paint and protectivecoating have your vehicle repaired as soon as possible.The cost of such repairs is considered the responsibil-ity of the owner.

• All wheels and wheel trim, especially aluminum andchrome plated wheels should be cleaned regularlywith mild soap and water to prevent corrosion. Toremove heavy soil, select a nonabrasive, non-acidiccleaner. Do not use scouring pads, steel wool, a bristlebrush or metal polishes. Only Mopar� cleaners arerecommended. Do not use oven cleaner. Avoid auto-matic car washes that use acidic solutions or harshbrushes that may damage the wheels’ protective fin-ish.

• If you carry special cargo such as chemicals, fertilizers,de-icer salt, etc., be sure that such materials are wellpackaged and sealed.

• If a lot of driving is done on gravel roads, considermud or stone shields behind each wheel.

• Use Mopar� touch up paint on scratches as soon aspossible. Your dealer has touch up paint to match thecolor of your vehicle.

Interior CareUse Mopar� Fabric Cleaner to clean fabric upholsteryand carpeting.

Use Mopar� Vinyl Cleaner to clean vinyl upholstery andtrim.

Mopar� Total Clean is specifically recommended forleather upholstery.

330 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 331: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Your leather upholstery can be best preserved by regularcleaning with a damp soft cloth. Small particles of dirtcan act as an abrasive and damage the leather upholsteryand should be removed promptly with a damp cloth.Stubborn soils can be removed easily with a soft clothand Mopar� Total Clean. Care should be taken to avoidsoaking your leather upholstery with any liquid. Pleasedo not use polishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, deter-gents, or ammonia based cleaners to clean your leatherupholstery. Application of a leather conditioner is notrequired to maintain the original condition.

WARNING!

Do not use volatile solvents for cleaning purposes.Many are potentially flammable, and if used inclosed areas they may cause respiratory harm.

Glass SurfacesAll glass surfaces should be cleaned on a regular basiswith any commercial household-type glass cleaner.Never use an abrasive type cleaner. Use caution whencleaning inside rear windows equipped with electricdefrosters or windshields equipped with a windshieldwiper de-icer. Do not use scrapers or other sharp instru-ments which may scratch the elements.

When cleaning the rear view mirror, spray cleaner on thetowel or rag that you are using. Do not spray cleanerdirectly on the mirror.

Cleaning Plastic Instrument Cluster LensesThe lenses in front of the instruments in this vehicle aremolded in clear plastic. When cleaning the lenses, caremust be taken to avoid scratching the plastic.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 331

7

Page 332: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

1. Clean with a wet soft rag. A mild soap solution may beused, but do not use high alcohol content or abrasivecleaners. If soap is used, wipe clean with a clean damprag.

2. Dry with a soft tissue.

Seat Belt MaintenanceDo not bleach, dye or clean the belts with chemicalsolvents or abrasive cleaners. This will weaken the fabric.Sun damage will also weaken the fabric.

If the belts need cleaning, use a mild soap solution orlukewarm water. Do not remove the belts from the car towash them.

Replace the belts if they appear frayed or worn or if thebuckles do not work properly.

POWER DISTRIBUTION CENTER (FUSE/RELAY)Your vehicle is equipped with an electrical power distri-bution center located on the left side of the enginecompartment.

These power distribution centers house new plug-in“Maxi” fuses which replace all the in-line fusible linkspreviously used. The power distribution centers alsocontain “Mini”fuses and plug-in “ISO” relays. A labelinside the latching cover of the Power Distribution Cen-ters identifies each component for ease of replacement, ifnecessary. These fuses and relays can be obtained fromyour dealer.

332 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 333: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

CAUTION!

When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to useonly a fuse having the correct amperage rating. Theuse of a fuse with a rating other than indicated mayresult in a dangerous electrical system overload. If aproperly rated fuse continues to blow, it suggests aproblem in the circuit that must be corrected.

NOTE: If you are leaving your vehicle dormant forlonger than 21 days you may want to take steps to protectyour battery. You may do this by disconnecting thebattery or by disconnecting the two ignition-off draw(I.O.D.) fuses located in the Auxiliary Power DistributionCenter (PDC) located in the engine compartment. TheI.O.D. cavities include a snap-in retainer that allows thefuse to be disconnected, without removing it from thefuse block. Pressing the I.O.D. fuse back into the cavityreconnects it.

VEHICLE STORAGEIf you are storing your vehicle for more than 21 days, werecommend that you take the following steps to mini-mize the drain on your vehicle’s battery:

• Disconnect the Ignition-Off Draw fuse (I.O.D.) fuselocated in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). TheI.O.D. cavity includes a snap-in retainer that allows thefuse to be disconnected, without removing it from thefuse block.

• The transfer case should be placed in the 4HI modeand kept in this position to minimize the battery drain.

• As an alternative to the above steps you may discon-nect the negative cable from the battery.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 333

7

Page 334: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

REPLACEMENT LIGHT BULBS

LIGHT BULBS — Interior Bulb No.Dome Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WL212–2Cargo Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 567Overhead Console Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192Reading Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . WL212–2

LIGHT BULBS — Outside Bulb No.Headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H13Front Park/Turn/Sidemarker . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3157NABack-Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3157Center High Mounted Stoplight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 921Fog Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9145Rear Sidemarker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168License Plate Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168Rear Tail, Stop, Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3057

BULB REPLACEMENT

Headlamps

Removing Attaching Screw

334 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 335: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

1. Open the hood.

2. Remove the 3 screws attaching the headlamp housingto the inner panel.

3. Grasp the headlamp and pull firmly to disengage theheadlamp housing from the fender panel.

Removing Headlamp Assembly Removing Headlamp Assembly

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 335

7

Page 336: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

4. While firmly holding the headlamp housing in yourhands unlock and disconnect Headlamp bulb connector.

5. Twist 1/4 turn and remove headlamp bulb and socketfrom housing and replace.

Removing Headlamp Bulb

Unlocking Connector

336 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 337: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Removing Headlamp from Assembly Removing Headlamp Bulb

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 337

7

Page 338: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

6. Reverse procedure to install new Headlamp bulb intothe headlamp assembly.

NOTE: These are Halogen bulbs. Take care not to touchthe bulb with your fingers. Body oils from your fingerscould cause excessive heat buildup which reduces bulblife.

Front Park and Turn Signal Lamp.

• Open the hood.

• Remove the (3 ) screws attaching the headlamp hous-ing to the inner panel.

• Grasp the headlamp and pull firmly to disengage theheadlamp housing from the fender panel.

Disconnecting Headlamp Bulb Connector

338 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 339: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTE: It is not necessary to disconnect the connector toreplace this bulb. If the bulb socket needs replacementdisconnect the connector.

• Rotate bulb socket 1/4 turn and remove socket fromhousing.

• Pull bulb straight from socket.

• Reverse procedure to install new turn signal bulb.

Removing Turn Signal BulbDisconnecting Turn Signal Connector

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 339

7

Page 340: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Rear Side Marker, Taillamps/Stoplamp, and TurnSignal Bulbs — Replacement

1. Remove the two (2) screws that pass through the bedsheetmetal.

2. Pull the taillamp housing straight out from the body.

Removing the Two (2) Screws

Pulling Housing From Body

340 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 341: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

3. Rotate the bulb socket from the housing. 4. Pull bulb straight out of socket.

Rotating Bulb Socket From Housing Pulling Bulb From Socket

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 341

7

Page 342: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

5. Reverse Procedure to install bulb and housing. Placethe two raised blocks passed the body.

Center High-Mounted Stoplamp And Cargo Lamp

1. Remove the two (2) screws holding the housing/lensto the body as shown.

Sliding Raised Blocks Past Body

Removing Screws

342 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 343: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

2. Remove housing from Cab 3. Remove connector from housing tab for more clear-ance.

Removing Housing from CabRemoving Connector from Tab

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 343

7

Page 344: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

4. Turn desired bulb socket 1⁄4 turn and remove socketand bulb from housing.

5. Pull desired bulb straight from the socket.

• Outside Bulbs: Cargo Lamps

• Inside Bulb: Center High Mount Stop Lamp

6. Reverse procedure for installation of bulbs and hous-ing.

Removing Socket From HousingPulling Bulb From Socket

344 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 345: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

License Lamps

1. Using a screw driver pry black rubber housing fromthe bumper.

2. Rotate the socket 1/4 turn counterclockwise.

Removing Housing From Bumper

Rotating Socket

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 345

7

Page 346: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

3. Pull bulb from socket.

4. Reverse procedure for installation.

Fog Lamps

1. Disconnect connector from fog lamp by raising wireharness lock tab and pulling on wire harness connector.

2. Rotate fog lamp bulb 1/4 turn counterclockwise andpull to remove from fog lamp housing.

3. Reverse Procedure to install.

Pulling Bulb From Socket

346 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 347: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

FLUIDS AND CAPACITIES

U.S. MetricFuel

3.7L/4.7L, 87 Octane 22 Gal. 83L4.7L HO, 91 Octane, Recommended Not Required 22 Gal 83L

Engine Oil (with filter)3.7L, SAE 5W-30, API Certified 5 Qt. 4.7L4.7L, SAE 5W-30, API Certified 6 Qt. 5.7L

4.7L HO, SAE 5W-30, API Certified 6 Qt. 5.7LCooling System (includes 2.1 Qts./2L for coolant bottle

3.7L (Mopar� Antifreeze/Coolant 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula) 13.3 Qt. 12.5L4.7L (Mopar� Antifreeze/Coolant 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula) 13.3 Qt. 12.5L

4.7L HO (Mopar� Antifreeze/Coolant 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula) 13.3 Qt. 12.5L

NOTE: All fluid capacities are approximate capacities.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 347

7

Page 348: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS AND GENUINE PARTS

Engine

Component Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine PartsEngine Coolant Mopar� Antifreeze/Coolant 5 Year/100,000 Mile Formula HOAT (Hybrid Or-

ganic Additive Technology) P/N 5011764AB or equivalent.Engine Oil Use SAE 5W-30, API Certified, meeting material standard MS-6395.Engine Oil Filter Mopar� Engine Oil Filter, P/N 5281090 or equivalent.Spark Plugs Refer to the Vehicle Emission Control Information label in the engine com-

partment.Fuel Selection 3.7L/4.7L 87 Octane, (R+M)/2 MethodFuel Selection 4.7L HO 91 Octane, (R+M)/2 Method (Recommend, Not Required.)

348 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE

Page 349: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Chassis

Component Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts.Automatic Transmission Mopar� ATF+4, Automatic Transmission Fluid.Manual Transmission (Getrag 238) Mopar� ATF+4, Automatic Transmission Fluid.Transfer Case Mopar� ATF+4, Automatic Transmission Fluid.Front Axle SAE 75W-90 Multipurpose Type, GL-5 Gear Lubricant (MS9763).Rear Axle SAE 75W-140 Synthetic Gear Lubricant (MS-8985). Limited-slip rear axles

require Mopar� limited-slip additive (MS-10111). Four ounces (118 ml)should be added to the gear lubricant whenever a fluid change is made.

Brake Master Cylinder Mopar� DOT 3 and SAE J1703 should be used. If DOT 3 brake fluid is notavailable, then DOT 4 is acceptable. Use only recommended brake fluids.

Power Steering Reservoir Mopar� ATF+4, Automatic Transmission Fluid.

MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 349

7

Page 350: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys
Page 351: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES

CONTENTS

� Emission Control System Maintenance . . . . . . . . 352

� Emissions Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352

� Maintenance Schedules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353

▫ Schedule “B” . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356

▫ Schedule “A” . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 352: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM MAINTENANCEThe “Scheduled” maintenance services, listed in boldtype on the following pages must be done at the times ormileages specified to assure the continued proper func-tioning of the emission control system. These, and allother maintenance services included in this manual,should be done to provide best vehicle performance andreliability. More frequent maintenance may be needed forvehicles in severe operating conditions such as dustyareas and very short trip driving.

Inspection and service also should be done any time amalfunction is suspected.

NOTE: Maintenance, replacement, or repair of the emis-sion control devices and systems on your vehicle may beperformed by any automotive repair establishment orindividual using any automotive part which has beencertified pursuant to U.S. EPA or, in the State of Califor-nia, California Air Resources Board regulations.

EMISSIONS TESTINGIn some localities, it may be or will become a legalrequirement to ensure that all emissions components andsystems are functioning properly as a part of the testprocedure. The test center accomplishes this by checkingthe On Board Diagnostic System (OBD) system with anelectronic scan tool. If your vehicle has recently beenserviced, the OBD system may have been reset to a �notready� condition because the OBD system has not hadsufficient time since the servicing to reconfirm thatemissions components are operating properly. In mostcases, a reasonable mix and amount of normal city andhighway driving and at least one overnight-off periodwill be required to prepare your vehicle for this check;however your dealer has the equipment and proceduresrequired to make certain that the OBD system of yourvehicle is ready for the required testing.

352 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 353: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

MAINTENANCE SCHEDULESThere are two maintenance schedules that show therequired service for your vehicle.

First is Schedule “B”. It is for vehicles that are operatedunder the conditions that are listed below and at thebeginning of the schedule.

• Day or night temperatures are below 32° F (0° C).

• Stop and go driving.

• Extensive engine idling.

• Driving in dusty conditions.

• Short trips of less than 10 miles (16 km).

• More than 50% of your driving is at sustained highspeeds during hot weather, above 90° F (32° C).

• Trailer towing.

• Taxi, police, or delivery service (commercial service).

• Off-road or desert operation.

• Heavy Loading

• If equipped for and operating with E-85 (ethanol)fuel.

NOTE: If ANY of these apply to you then change yourengine oil every 3,000 miles (5 000 km) or 3 months,whichever comes first and follow schedule “B” of the�Maintenance Schedules� section of this manual.

NOTE: If ANY of these apply to you then change yourcoolant every 102,000 miles (175 000 km) or 60 months,whichever comes first and follow schedule “B” of the�Maintenance Schedules� section of this manual.

Second is Schedule “A”. It is for vehicles that are notoperated under any of the conditions listed under Sched-ule �B�.

MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 353

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 354: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Use the schedule that best describes your driving condi-tions. Where time and mileage are listed, follow theinterval that occurs first.

NOTE: Under no circumstances should oil change in-tervals exceed 6000 miles (10 000 km) or 6 monthswhichever comes first.

CAUTION!

Failure to perform the required maintenance itemsmay result in damage to the vehicle.

At Each Stop for Fuel

• Check the engine oil level about 5 minutes after a fullywarmed engine is shut off. Checking the oil level whilethe vehicle is on level ground will improve the accu-racy of the oil level reading. Add oil only when thelevel is at or below the ADD or MIN mark.

• Check the windshield washer solvent and add, ifrequired.

Once a Month

• Check tire pressure and look for unusual wear ordamage.

• Inspect the battery and clean and tighten the terminalsas required.

354 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 355: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

• Check the fluid levels of coolant reservoir, brakemaster cylinder, and transmission and add as needed.

• Check all lights and all other electrical items for correctoperation.

At Each Oil Change

• Change the engine oil filter.

• Inspect the exhaust system.

• Inspect the brake hoses.

• Inspect the CV joints (if equipped) and front suspen-sion components.

• Check the automatic transmission fluid level (ifequipped).

• Check the manual transmission fluid level (ifequipped).

• Check the coolant level, hoses, and clamps.

MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 355

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 356: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Schedule “B”Follow schedule “B” if you usually operate your vehicleunder one or more of the following conditions.

• Day or night temperatures are below 32° F (0° C).

• Stop and go driving.

• Extensive engine idling.

• Driving in dusty conditions.

• Short trips of less than 10 miles (16 km).

• More than 50% of your driving is at sustained highspeeds during hot weather, above 90° F (32° C).

• Trailer towing.

• Taxi, police, or delivery service (commercial service).

• Off-road or desert operation.

• Heavy Loading

• If equipped for and operating with E-85 (ethanol)fuel.

NOTE: If ANY of these apply to you then change yourengine oil every 3,000 miles (5 000 km) or 3 months,whichever comes first and follow schedule “B” of the�Maintenance Schedules� section of this manual.

NOTE: If ANY of these apply to you then change yourcoolant every 102,000 miles (175 000 km) or 60 months,whichever comes first and follow schedule “B” of the�Maintenance Schedules� section of this manual.

356 SCHEDULE “B”

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 357: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 3,000 6,000 9,000 12,000 15,000(Kilometers) (5 000) (10 000) (15 000) (20 000) (25 000)Change engine oil and engine oil filter, or at 3months whichever comes first. X X X X X

Rotate tires. X XCheck spare tire for proper pressure and correctstowage. X X

Change rear axle fluid. XChange front axle fluid (4X4). XInspect engine air cleaner filter, replace if neces-sary. X

SCHEDULE “B” 357

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 358: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 18,000 21,000 24,000 27,000 30,000(Kilometers) (30 000) (35 000) (40 000) (45 000) (50 000)Change engine oil and engine oil filter, or at 3months whichever comes first.

X X X X X

Rotate tires. X X XCheck spare tire for proper pressure and correctstowage. X X X

Change rear axle fluid. XChange front axle fluid (4X4). XCheck transfer case fluid level (4X4). XInspect brake linings. XInspect engine air cleaner filter, replace if neces-sary.

X

Replace spark plugs. XInspect PCV valve, replace as necessary.** X

358 SCHEDULE “B”

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 359: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 33,000 36,000 39, 000 42,000 45,000(Kilometers) (55 000) (60 000) (65 000) (70 000) (75 000)Change engine oil and engine oil filter, or at 3months whichever comes first.

X X X X X

Rotate tires. X XCheck spare tire for proper pressure and correctstowage. X X

Change rear axle fluid. XChange front axle fluid (4X4). XInspect brake linings. XInspect engine air cleaner filter, replace if neces-sary.

X

SCHEDULE “B” 359

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 360: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 48,000 51,000 54,000 57,000 60,000(Kilometers) (80 000) (85 000) (90 000) (95 000) (100 000)Change engine oil and engine oil filter, or at 3months whichever comes first.

X X X X X

Rotate tires. X X XCheck spare tire for proper pressure and correctstowage. X X X

Change rear axle fluid. XChange front axle fluid (4X4). XInspect brake linings. XInspect engine air cleaner filter, replace if neces-sary.

X

Replace spark plugs. XInspect PCV valve, replace as necessary.** XInspect auto tension drive belt and replace, if re-quired.

X

Drain and refill automatic transmission fluid,change filter (3.7L).

X

360 SCHEDULE “B”

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 361: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 48,000 51,000 54,000 57,000 60,000(Kilometers) (80 000) (85 000) (90 000) (95 000) (100 000)Drain and refill automatic transmission fluid andchange main sump filter (4.7L).

X

Inspect transfer case fluid (4X4). XFlush and replace engine coolant at 60 months, or102, 000 miles (175 000 km) whichever comes first. X

SCHEDULE “B” 361

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 362: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 63,000 66,000 69,000 72,000 75,000(Kilometers) (105 000) (110 000) (115 000) (120 000) (125 000)Change engine oil and engine oil filter, or at 3months whichever comes first.

X X X X

Rotate tires. X XCheck spare tire for proper pressure and correctstowage. X X

Change rear axle fluid. XChange front axle fluid (4X4). XInspect brake linings. XInspect engine air cleaner filter, replace if neces-sary.

X

Inspect auto tension drive belt and replace, if re-quired.

X

362 SCHEDULE “B”

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 363: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 78,000 81,000 84,000 87,000 90,000(Kilometers ) (130 000) (135 000) (140 000) (145 000) (150 000)Change engine oil and engine oil filter, or at 3months whichever comes first.

X X X X X

Rotate tires. X X XCheck spare tire for proper pressure and correctstowage. X X X

Change rear axle fluid. XChange front axle fluid (4X4). XCheck transfer case fluid level (4X4). XInspect brake linings. XInspect engine air cleaner filter, replace if neces-sary.

X

Replace spark plugs. XInspect PCV valve, replace as necessary.** XInspect auto tension drive belt and replace, if re-quired.

X

SCHEDULE “B” 363

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 364: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 93,000 96,000 99,000 100,000 102,000(Kilometers) (155 000) (160 000) (165 000) (170 000) (175 000)Change engine oil and engine oil filter, or at 3months whichever comes first.

X X X X

Rotate tires. X XCheck spare tire for proper pressure and correctstowage. X X

Flush and replace engine coolant, if not done at 60months. X

Change rear axle fluid. XChange front axle fluid (4X4). X

364 SCHEDULE “B”

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 365: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 105,000 108,000 111,000 114,000 117,000 120,000(Kilometers) (180 000) (185 000) (190 000) (195 000) (200 000) (205 000)Change engine oil and engine oil filter, or at 3months whichever comes first.

X X X X X X

Rotate tires. X X XCheck spare tire for proper pressure and cor-rect stowage. X X X

Change rear axle fluid. X XChange front axle fluid (4X4). X XInspect brake linings. XInspect engine air cleaner filter, replace ifnecessary.

X X

Replace spark plugs. XInspect PCV valve, replace as necessary.** XInspect auto tension drive belt and replace, ifrequired.

X X

Drain and refill transfer case fluid (4X4). X

SCHEDULE “B” 365

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 366: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 105,000 108,000 111,000 114,000 117,000 120,000(Kilometers) (180 000) (185 000) (190 000) (195 000) (200 000) (205 000)Drain and refill automatic transmission fluid,change filter (3.7L).

X

Drain and refill automatic transmission fluidand change main sump filter and spin-oncooler return filter if equipped. (4.7L).

X

Flush and replace engine coolant, if not re-placed at 102,000 miles (175 000 km).

X

This applies only if your vehicle is used for police, taxi,fleet, or frequent trailer towing.

Inspection and service should also be performed anytimea malfunction is observed or suspected. Retain all re-ceipts.

** This maintenance is recommended by the manufac-turer to the owner, but not required to maintain theemissions warranty.

366 SCHEDULE “B”

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 367: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Schedule “A”

Miles 6,000 12,000 18,000 24,000 30,000(Kilometers) (10 000) (20 000) (30 000) (40 000) (50 000)[Months] [6] [12] [18] [24] [30]Change engine oil and engine oil filter. X X X X XRotate tires. X X X X XCheck spare tire for proper pressure and correctstowage. X X X X X

Check transfer case fluid level (4X4). XInspect brake linings. XInspect engine air cleaner filter, replace as neces-sary. X

Replace spark plugs. X

SCHEDULE “A” 367

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 368: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 36,000 42,000 48,000 54000 60,000 66,000(Kilometers) (60 000) (70 000) (80 000) (90 000) (100 000) (110 000)[Months] [36] [42] [48] [54] [60] [66]Change engine oil and engine oil filter. X X X X X XRotate tires. X X X X X XCheck spare tire for proper pressure and cor-rect stowage. X X X X X X

Check transfer case fluid level (4X4). XFlush and replace engine coolant at 60months, if not replaced at 102,000 miles (185000 km).

X

Inspect brake linings. X XInspect engine air cleaner filter, replace ifnecessary. X

Replace spark plugs. XInspect PCV valve, replace as necessary.** XInspect auto tension drive belt and replace, ifrequired. X

368 SCHEDULE “A”

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 369: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 72,000 78,000 84,000 90,000 96,000 100,000(Kilometers) (120 000) (130 000) (140 000) (150 000) (160 000) (170 000)[Months] [72] [78] [84] [90] [96]Change engine oil and engine oil filter. X X X X XRotate tires. X X X X X XCheck spare tire for proper pressure and cor-rect stowage. X X X X X

Check transfer case fluid level (4X4). XInspect brake linings. X XInspect engine air cleaner filter, replace ifnecessary.

X

Replace spark plugs. XInspect PCV valve, replace as necessary.** XInspect auto tension drive belt and replace, ifrequired.

X

SCHEDULE “A” 369

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 370: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Miles 102,000 108,000 114,000 120,000(Kilometers) (180 000) (190 000) (200 000) (210 000)[Months] [102] [108] [114] [120]Change engine oil and engine oil filter. X X X XRotate tires. X X X XCheck spare tire for proper pressure and correct stowage. X X X XDrain and refill tranfer case fluid (4X4). XFlush and replace engine coolant, if not done at 60months. X

Flush and replace engine coolant, if not done at 102,000miles (180 000 km) X

Inspect brake linings. XInspect engine air cleaner filter, replace as necessary. XReplace spark plugs. XInspect PCV valve, replace as necessary.** X

370 SCHEDULE “A”

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 371: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

** This maintenance is recommended by the manufac-turer to the owner, but not required to maintain theemissions warranty.

Inspection and service should also be performed anytimea malfunction is observed or suspected. Retain all re-ceipts.

WARNING!

You can be badly injured working on or around amotor vehicle. Do only that service work for whichyou have the knowledge and the right equipment. Ifyou have any doubt about your ability to perform aservice job, take your vehicle to a competent me-chanic.

SCHEDULE “A” 371

8

MAINTENANCE

SCHEDULES

Page 372: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys
Page 373: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE

CONTENTS

� Suggestions For Obtaining Service ForYour Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374

▫ Prepare For The Appointment . . . . . . . . . . . . 374

▫ Prepare A List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374

▫ Be Reasonable With Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374

� If You Need Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374

� Warranty Information (U.S. Vehicles Only) . . . . . 377

� Mopar� Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377

� Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377

▫ In Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377

� Publication Order Forms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378

9

Page 374: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FORYOUR VEHICLE

Prepare For The AppointmentIf you’re having warranty work done, be sure to have theright papers with you. Take your warranty folder. Allwork to be performed may not be covered by thewarranty, discuss additional charges with the servicemanager. Keep a maintenance log of your vehicle’sservice history. This can often provide a clue to thecurrent problem.

Prepare A ListMake a written list of your vehicle’s problems or thespecific work you want done. If you’ve had an accident,or work done that is not on your maintenance log, let theservice advisor know.

Be Reasonable With RequestsIf you list a number of items, and you must have yourvehicle by the end of the day, discuss the situation withthe service advisor and list the items in order of priority.At many dealers you may obtain a rental vehicle at aminimal daily charge. If you need a rental, it is advisableto make these arrangements when you call for an ap-pointment.

IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCEThe manufacturer and its dealers are vitally interested inyour satisfaction. We want you to be happy with ourproducts and services.

Warranty service must be done by an authorizedChrysler, Dodge, or Jeep dealer. We strongly recommendthat you take your vehicle to you selling dealer. Theyknow you and your vehicle best, and are most concernedthat you get prompt and high quality service. Themanufacturer’s dealers have the facilities, factory-trained

374 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE

Page 375: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

technicians, special tools, and the latest information toassure your vehicle is fixed correctly and in a timelymanner.

This is why you should always talk to your dealer’sservice manager first. Most matters can be resolved withthis process.

• If for some reason you are still not satisfied, talk to thegeneral manager or owner of the dealership. Theywant to know if you need assistance.

• If your dealership is unable to resolve the concern, youmay contact the Manufacturer’s Customer Center.

Any communication to the Manufacturer’s CustomerCenter should include the following information:

• Owner’s name and address

• Owner’s telephone number (home and office)

• Dealership name

• Vehicle identification number

• Vehicle delivery date and mileage

DaimlerChrysler Motors Corporation Customer CenterP.O. Box 21–8004Auburn Hills, MI 48321–8004Phone: (800) 992-1997

DaimlerChrysler Canada Inc. Customer CenterP.O. Box 1621Windsor, Ontario N9A 4H6Phone —(800) 465–2001

In Mexico contact:Av. Prolongacion Paseo de la Reforma, 1240Sante Fe C.P. 05109Mexico, D. F.In Mexico (915) 729–1248 or 729–1240Outside Mexico (525) 729–1248 or 729–1240

IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 375

9

Page 376: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or SpeechImpaired (TDD/TTY)To assist customers who have hearing difficulties, themanufacturer has installed special TDD (Telecommuni-cation Devices for the Deaf) equipment at its CustomerCenter. Any hearing or speech impaired customer whohas access to a TDD or a conventional teletypewriter(TTY) in the United States can communicate with themanufacturer by dialing 1–800–380–CHRY.

Service ContractYou may have purchased a service contract for yourvehicle to help protect you from the high cost of unex-pected repairs after your manufacturer’s new vehiclelimited warranty expires. The manufacturer stands be-hind only the manufacturer’s Service Contracts. If youpurchased a manufacturer’s Service Contract, you willreceive Plan Provisions and an Owner Identification Cardin the mail within three weeks of your vehicle deliverydate. If you have any questions about your service

contract, call the manufacturer’s Service Contract Na-tional Customer Hotline at 1-800-521-9922.

The manufacturer will not stand behind any servicecontract that is not the manufacturer’s Service Contract. Itis not responsible for any service contract other than themanufacturer’s Service Contract. If you purchased aservice contract that is not a manufacturer’s ServiceContract, and you require service after your manufactur-er’s new vehicle limited warranty expires, please refer toyour contract documents, and contact the person listed inthose documents.

We appreciate that you have made a major investmentwhen you purchased your new vehicle. Your dealer hasalso made a major investment in facilities, tools, andtraining to assure that you are absolutely delighted withyour ownership experience. You’ll be pleased with theirsincere efforts to resolve any warranty issues or relatedconcerns.

376 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE

Page 377: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

WARRANTY INFORMATION (U.S. Vehicles Only)See the Warranty Information Booklet for the terms andprovisions of DaimlerChrysler’s warranties applicable tothis vehicle.

MOPAR� PARTSMopar� fluids, lubricants, parts, and accessories areavailable from your dealer. They will help you keep yourvehicle operating at its best.

REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTSIn the 50 United States and Washington D.C.: If youbelieve that your vehicle has a defect which could causea crash or cause injury or death, you should immediatelyinform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administra-tion (NHTSA) in addition to notifying the manufacturer.

If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open aninvestigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists ina group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy

campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved inindividual problems between you, your dealer, and themanufacturer.

To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto SafetyHotline toll free at 1-800-424-9393 (or 366-0123 in Wash-ington DC area) or write to: NHTSA, U.S. Dept. ofTransportation, Washington DC 20590. You can alsoobtain other information about motor vehicle safety fromthe Hotline.

In Canada:If you believe that your vehicle has a safety defect, youshould contact the Customer Service Department imme-diately. Canadian customers who wish to report a safetydefect to the Canadian government should write toTransport Canada, Motor Vehicle Defect Investigationsand Recalls, 2780 Sheffield Road, Ottawa, Ontario K1B3V9.

IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 377

9

Page 378: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

PUBLICATION ORDER FORMSTo order the following manuals, you may use either thewebsite or the phone numbers listed below. Visa, Mas-tercard, American Express, and Discover orders are ac-cepted. If you prefer mailing your payment, please callfor an order form.

NOTE: A street address is required when orderingmanuals. (No P.O. Boxes).

• Service Manuals.

These comprehensive service manuals provide theinformation that students and professional techniciansneed in diagnosing/troubleshooting, problem solving,maintaining, servicing and repairing DaimlerChryslerCorporation vehicles. A complete working knowledgeof the vehicle, system and/or components is written instraightforward language with illustrations, diagramsand charts.

• Diagnostic Procedure Manuals.

Filled with diagrams, charts and detailed illustrations,these practical manuals make it easy for students andtechnicians to find and fix problems on computer-controlled vehicle systems and features. They showexactly how to find and correct problems the first time,using step-by-step troubleshooting and driveabilityprocedures, proven diagnostic tests and a complete listof all tools and equipment.

• Owner’s Manuals.

These manuals have been prepared with the assistanceof service and engineering specialists to acquaint youwith specific Chrysler group vehicles. Included arestarting, operating, emergency and maintenance pro-cedures as well as specifications, capabilities andsafety tips.

378 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE

Page 379: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Call Toll Free at:

• 1–800–890–4038 (U.S.)

• 1–800–387–1143 (Canada)

Or

Visit us on the World Wide Web at:

• www.techauthority.daimlerchrysler.com

• www.daimlerchrysler.ca/manuals

IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 379

9

Page 380: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys
Page 381: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

INDEX

10

Page 382: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Adding Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247,276Air Cleaner, Engine (Engine Air Cleaner Filter) . . . 307Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184Air Conditioning, Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . 185,188Air Conditioning Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311,312Air Conditioning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184,311Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307Air Pressure, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234,242Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40,54,158Airbag Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54Airbag On/Off Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26,154Alarm, Panic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23Alignment and Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241Alterations/Modifications, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6Antenna, Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . . . . 317,318,347Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222

Anti-Lock Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155Anti-Theft System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26,154Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328Arming Theft System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27Auto Unlock, Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17Automatic Dimming Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197,200,324

Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324Fluid and Filter Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325Fluid Level Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324Fluid Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325,349Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200Special Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326Torque Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204

Axle Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349Axle Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327

382 INDEX

Page 383: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Ball Joints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309

Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287Emergency Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287Gas Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287Keyless Transmitter Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . 25Saving Feature (Protection) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114

Belts, Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306Belts, Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31Body Mechanism Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313B-Pillar Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229Brake Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221,321

Anti-Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222Disc Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321Fluid Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321Hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323Master Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220

Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155,156Brake/Transmission Interlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200Break-In Recommendations, New Vehicle . . . . . . . . 71Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334Bulbs, Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334

Calibration, Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129Camper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145Capacities, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347Caps, Filler

Oil (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312

Car Washes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329Carbon Monoxide Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146,250Cargo Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116Cargo (Vehicle Loading) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252Catalytic Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250,308CD Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160,166Cellular Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82,184

INDEX 383

10

Page 384: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Center High Mounted Stop Light . . . . . . . . . . . . 342Center Seat Storage Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . 143Certification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252Changing A Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287Chart, Tire Sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58,59Child Restraint Tether Anchors . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61,66Child Restraint with Automatic Belts . . . . . . . . . . . 37Child Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332Climate Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159Compact Disc Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129Compass Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129Compass Variance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130Computer, Trip/Travel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125

Console, Floor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142Console, Overhead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124Contract, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376Converter, Catalytic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319Coolant Pressure Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315

Adding Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318Coolant Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347Coolant Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319Disposal of Used Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317Drain, Flush, and Refill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315Points to Remember . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319Radiator Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318Selection of Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . 317,347,348Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152

Cruise Control (Speed Control) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121Cup Holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144

384 INDEX

Page 385: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374

Data Recorder, Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56Daytime Running Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115Dealer Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301Defroster, Rear Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191Defroster, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73,186Delay (Intermittent) Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118Diagnostic System, Onboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298Differential, Limited-Slip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219Dimmer Switch, Headlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153Dipsticks

Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324Oil (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312

Disarming, Theft System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27Disc Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321Disposal

Used Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317

Door Ajar Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15Door Opener, Garage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131Drive Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306Drive Shaft Universal Joints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313

Electric Remote Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81Electrical Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140Electronic Speed Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121Emergency, In Case of

Freeing Vehicle When Stuck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318Tow Hooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290

Emission Control System Maintenance . . . . . . . . . 352Emission Related Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320Engine

Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307

INDEX 385

10

Page 386: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Block Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199Break-In Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317,348Cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315Exhaust Gas Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72,250Fails to Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198Flooded, Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302,347,348Oil Filler Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305Oil Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347Oil Synthetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152

Entry System, Illuminated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14Equipment Identification Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273

Ethylene Glycol Antifreeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317Event Data Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56Exhaust Gas Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72,250,315Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72,315Extender, Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39Exterior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114

FiltersAir Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307Engine Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306,348Engine Oil Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306

FlashersHazard Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117,152,340

Flat Tire Stowage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286Flooded Engine Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198Floor Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142Fluid, Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349

386 INDEX

Page 387: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Fluid Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347Fluid Level Checks

Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312Transfer Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326

Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts . . . . . . . . . . 348Fog Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116,346Four Wheel Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207

Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207Four-Way Hazard Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276Freeing A Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224Front Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245

Adding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152

Octane Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245,348Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245,347Tank Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347

Fueling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332

Garage Door Opener . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131Gas Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248,299Gas Gauge (Fuel Gauge) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245Gasoline, Reformulated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246Gauges

Coolant Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155,156Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155

Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200Glass Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331

INDEX 387

10

Page 388: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Grease . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327Gross Axle Weight Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253,256Gross Cargo Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252Gross Vehicle Weight Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255GVWR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252,255

Hands-Free Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334

High Beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118High Beam/Low Beam Select Switch . . . . . . . . 118Lights On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117Replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114

Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110Heater, Engine Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199High Beam Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153

High Beam/Low Beam Select (Dimmer) Switch . . 118Hitches

Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258Holder, Cup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144Homelink Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131Hood Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111Hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320

Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10,13Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13

Illuminated Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14Infant Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58Inflation Pressure Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242Inside Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152Instrument Panel and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150Instrument Panel Lens Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331Interior Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330

388 INDEX

Page 389: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113Intermittent Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4

Jack Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277,282Jacking Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283

Key, Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11Key, Sentry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10Key-In Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10Keyless Entry System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10Knee Bolster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40

Lane Change and Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . 117,152,340Lap/Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tether for CHildren) . 61Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73,112

Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54,158

Anti-Lock Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155Back-Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340Brake Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334Cargo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116Center Mounted Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342Courtesy/Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125Cruise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158Daytime Running . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115Door Ajar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156Fog . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116,153,346Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114High Beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118High Beam/Low Beam Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152Intensity Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113,125License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345

INDEX 389

10

Page 390: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Lights On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116Low Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152,153Malfunction Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117,340Warning (Instrument Cluster Description) . . . . . 152Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157

Limited-Slip Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219Loading Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252

Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15

Auto Unlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17Automatic Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17Child Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10

Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16Steering Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13

Lower Anchors and Tether for CHildren (LATCH) . 61Lubricating Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327Lubrication, Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313Lug Nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285Lumbar Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107

Maintenance Free Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309Maintenance Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353

Schedule �A� . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367Schedule �B� . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356

Maintenance, Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140Malfunction Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157,299Manual, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197,205,323

Fluid Level Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323Lubricant Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323,349

390 INDEX

Page 391: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Map/Reading Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79

Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80Electric Powered . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82Outside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266

Modifications/Alterations, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6Mopar Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301,377Multi-Function Control Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117

New Vehicle Break-In Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71

Occupant Classification System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44Occupant Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30Octane Rating, Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245Oil, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302,348

Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347

Change Interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303Dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306,348Filter Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306Identification Logo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304Materials Added to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305Recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304,347Synthetic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305Viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305,347

Onboard Diagnostic System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298,299Opener, Garage Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131Outside Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80Overdrive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155,202Overdrive OFF Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202Overhead Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124,125Overhead Travel Information Center . . . . . . . . . . 125Overheating, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154,318Owner’s Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378

INDEX 391

10

Page 392: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Panic Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220Parking On Hill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220Passenger Airbag On/Off Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54Passing Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71Pets, Transporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71Phone, Cellular . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82Phone, Hands-Free . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82Placard, Tire and Loading Information . . . . . . . . . 230Positive Crankcase Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320Power

Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321Distribution Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14,16Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81Outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224,312Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138

Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28Power Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349Pregnant Women and Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39Preparation for Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282Pretensioners

Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37Programmable Electronic Features . . . . . . . . . 132,136Programming Transmitters . . . . . . . . . . . . 24,132,136

Quad Cab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110

Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236Radiator Cap (Coolant Pressure Cap) . . . . . . . . . . 318Radio Broadcast Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160,166,184Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159Radio, Satellite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178Radio (Sound Systems) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160,166Rear Axle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327

392 INDEX

Page 393: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Rear Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30Rear Window Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79Reception, Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159Reclining Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106Recorder, Event Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56Recreational Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267

Shifting into Transfer Case Neutral (N) . . . . . . . 268Shifting out of Transfer Case Neutral (N) . . . . . 270

Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312Release, Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111Reminder, Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38Remote Keyless Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20Remote Sound System Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377

Restraints, Child . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58,63Restraints, Occupant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30Rocking Vehicle When Stuck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224Rotation, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244

Safety Checks Inside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73Safety Checks Outside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73Safety Defects, Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377Safety Information, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225Safety Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178Satellite Radio Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181Schedule, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353Seat Belt Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30,31

And Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58,59Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39

INDEX 393

10

Page 394: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Front Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73Pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153

Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110Lumbar Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107Reclining . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106

Security Alarm (Theft Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26,154Selection of Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348Selection of Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304Sentry Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10Sentry Key Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12Service and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302,352,353Service Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376Service Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160

Shift Speeds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206Shifting

Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200Manual Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205Transfer Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207Transfer Case, Shifting into Transfer

Case Neutral (N) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268Transfer Case, Shifting out of Transfer

Case Neutral (N) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270Shoulder Belt Upper Anchorage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31Signals, Turn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117,152,340Snow Chains (Tire Chains) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242Snow Plow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237,238,279Spark Plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307Speed Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154

394 INDEX

Page 395: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197Emergency (Jump Starting) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287Engine Block Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199

SteeringColumn Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117Column Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224,312Wheel, Tilt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120

Steering Wheel Mounted Sound SystemControls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182

Storage Compartment, Center Seat . . . . . . . . . . . 143Storage, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333Stuck, Freeing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224Sun Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138Sunroof Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140Supplemental Tire Pressure Information . . . . . . . . 242Synthetic Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305

Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155

Tailgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144Taillights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340Temperature Gauge, Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . 152Tether Anchor, Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61Theft System Arming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27Theft System Disarming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27Thermostat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320Tilt Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120Tire and Loading Information Placard . . . . 229,230,242Tire Identification Number (TIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225Tire Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73,233

Air Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233

INDEX 395

10

Page 396: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

High Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234Jacking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282Load Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229,230Radial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225,233Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239Wheel Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282Wheel Nut Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285

Tongue Weight/Trailer Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259Torque Converter Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204Tow Hooks, Emergency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255

Disabled Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259Recreational . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259

Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255

Cooling System Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266Hitches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258Minimum Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266Trailer and Tongue Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263

Trailer Towing Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259Trailer Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200

Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200

Transfer Case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349

396 INDEX

Page 397: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200,324Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197,200,324Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323,325,349Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197,205,323Shifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206

Transmitter Battery Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25Transmitter, Garage Door Opener . . . . . . . . . . . . 131Transmitter Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155Trip Odometer Reset Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117,152,340

Universal Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131Unlock, Auto . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17

Vacuum/Vapor Harnesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320Variance, Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130Vehicle Identification Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5Vehicle Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230,252Vehicle Modifications/Alterations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6Vehicle Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333

Warning Lights (Instrument Cluster Description) . 152Warnings and Cautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5Warranty Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377Washers, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119Washing Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329Weight Load Carrying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252Wheel Alignment and Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241Wheel and Wheel Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330Wheel Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277Wheel Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282Wheel Nut Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30

INDEX 397

10

Page 398: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

Window Fogging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28

Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28Windshield Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73,186Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118,119,314

Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118,314Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313Wipers, Intermittent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118Wrecker Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290

398 INDEX

Page 399: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTES

Page 400: SECTION TABLE OF CONTENTS PAGE€¦ · If you do not read this entire manual you may miss important information. ... keys from your dealer or a locksmith. If you received your keys

NOTES